DDS-CAD 7.3 Manual ENG PDF
DDS-CAD 7.3 Manual ENG PDF
DDS-CAD 7.3 Manual ENG PDF
Editor's note
This document was last revised on 23 August 2012. The first online edition
will be published in October 2012. A complete list of revisions can be found
on the following page.
We have several additions planned for the coming weeks. These topics are
denoted in the table of contents by double brackets. Topics that are
currently under revision are denoted by single brackets:
Basic functions
((Scheduled topic))
(Topic under revision)
If you have any questions on these or other topics, please refer to our
"History/changes" documentation in the "Help" menu.
If you have taken out a software maintenance agreement with us, you will
receive our regular online updates. This automatically includes an updated
configuration
configuration
version of the manual. As a user without a software maintenance
agreement, you can download the manual from our website
(www.dds-cad.com).
Yours sincerely,
extensions,
extensions,
Jens Ackermann
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
1
Introduction
Editor's note
Strategies for handling projects
2
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Foreword
Basic functions
solutions, and to compare these to each other. Realisation is not without alterations
and management may also result in additions, inspections and repairs.
Documentation is always the source of information, the medium of communication
and the basis for actions.
The use of virtual models therefore appears to make sense: a model evolves
dynamically with the project. It accompanies the system even after its construction,
makes it possible to simulate subsequent changes and disturbing influences and
configuration
simplifies troubleshooting. The individual document is always a derivation from the
configuration
model.
Data Design System has been committed to the model way of thinking for more than
25 years. During this time, our product, DDS-CAD has evolved into a high-
extensions,
performance product with complex structures and interfaces for the widest variety of
extensions,
This manual is designed to help you integrate DDS-CAD 7.3 in your day-to-day work.
Adjustments,
1
We continuously update it with our online updates . It is freely available from our
Adjustments,
website (www.dds-cad.com).
1
You will receive these automatically if you have signed a software maintenance agreement with us.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
3
Introduction
Foreword
This manual is intended for users with no practical experience with DDS-CAD. It is
divided into roughly four subject areas:
Part I introduces you to the DDS-CAD product philosophy. This section explains the
structure of the user interface and project management.
Part II explains the strategies for handling projects with DDS-CAD. It begins with
editing the floor plan, the building model, the building services model and their
calculation and evaluation.
Part III contains a description of the DDS basic functions, such as working with
geometric shapes, text, auxiliary and editing functions, etc.
Input elements
Basic functions
Key (keyboard)
Left mouse button
Middle mouse button (scroll wheel)
Right mouse button
Input
4
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Contents
PART I – INTRODUCTION 14
3 AN INTRODUCTION TO DDS-CAD 19
3.1 Starting the program 19
3.2 Creating and managing projects 19
3.2.1 Project setup and the structure of the drawings list 19
3.2.2 Using the list of drawings in project management 22
3.2.3 Notes on the root directory for projects 24
3.3 At the drawing level 25
3.3.1 The user interface 25
3.3.2 The internal structure of a DDS drawing 26
Basic functions
4.1.1 DWG and DXF 33
4.1.2 Portable Document Format (*.PDF) 33
4.1.3 Raster image (*.BMP; *.GIF; *.JPG; *.PNG; *.TIF; *.WMF) 33
4.2 The general import process 34
4.2.1 Copying files to the project 34
4.2.2 Importing 35
4.3 Notes on working with floor plans 35
4.3.1 Requirements for imported floor plans 35
4.3.2 Checking and correcting the scale ratio 38
4.3.3 Accurate placement of the storeys 41
configuration
4.3.4 Notes on importing altered plans 43
configuration
4.4 Imported files when exporting the model 45
5 BUILDING MODEL 47
5.1 Components and structural design 48
5.2 Requirements for the building model 49
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
5
Introduction
Contents
6 VENTILATION SYSTEMS 81
6.1 Entering and calculating the volume flows 82
6.1.1 Checking and correcting building data 82
6.1.2 Check and correct room data 83
6.1.3 controlled ventilation of residential buildings 83
6.2 Objects of the ventilation system 86
6.2.1 Air handling unit 86
6.2.2 Air terminals 86
6.2.3 Substitute object for simulating sub-networks/consumers 87
6
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Contents
Basic functions
9.3.1 Starting point and direction of the first segment 167
9.3.2 Drawing the pipeline route 176
9.3.3 The last segment, position and type of the endpoint 180
9.4 Auxiliary functions for constructing a network 182
9.4.1 Creating parallel pipes 182
9.4.2 The copy function for sub-sections 183
9.4.3 Incorporating free sub-sections into the overall network 187
9.4.4 Connecting objects automatically 188
9.5 Fixtures and fittings in pipes 198
9.5.1 Features common to all pipeline objects 198
9.5.2 Notes on the various pipeline objects 200
configuration
9.5.3 Manual installation of pipeline objects 201
configuration
9.6 Moulded parts and devices in the ventilation duct 203
9.6.1 Moulded parts in the ventilation duct 203
9.6.2 Devices in the ventilation duct 204
9.7 Segments in the pipeline route 205
9.7.1 Changing the material or colour in the pipeline route 205
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
7
Introduction
Contents
8
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Contents
Basic functions
13.5.5 Drawing a cable 339
13.5.6 Installation spanning several storeys 341
configuration
14.3 Drawing circuits automatically 349
configuration
14.3.1 Organising sheet divisions 349
14.3.2 Specifying the start position before drawing 350
14.4 Drawing manually 351
14.4.1 Draw components 351
14.4.2 Drawing terminals 352
extensions,
14.5 Navigating between the circuit and the sheet 353
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
9
Introduction
Contents
10
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Contents
Basic functions
19.2.8 Pyramid 470
19.2.9 Prism 471
19.2.10 Truncated pyramid (polyhedron) 473
19.2.11 Ball 475
19.2.12 Ellipse 476
19.2.13 Elliptic arc 477
19.2.14 Network 478
19.3 Working with auxiliary geometries 479
19.3.1 Auxiliary geometry on an active point 479
19.3.2 Help geometry on active circle/arc 483
configuration
19.3.3 Help geometry on active line 484
configuration
19.3.4 Delete help geometry 487
19.4 Working with text and labels 488
19.4.1 Symbol text on objects, pipelines and in rooms 488
19.4.2 Position marker (on objects) 494
19.4.3 Free text 497
19.4.4 Move text and labels 498
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
11
Introduction
Contents
21.3.5 Correcting the position of the objects in the DDS model 528
21.3.6 Hide original 528
21.3.7 Notes on the parts list 530
21.4 Apply changes – Save 531
12
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Contents
Basic functions
24.1.4 Variant 591
24.1.5 Types (of a variant) 592
24.2 Start editing mode 594
24.3 The layout manager 595
24.4 The user interface in editing mode 595
24.5 Configuring a circuit 597
24.6 Drawing in editing mode 598
24.6.1 Symbols for the equipment 598
24.6.2 Wiring lines and wiring points 598
24.6.3 Space requirement – start position of the next circuit 601
configuration
configuration
24.7 Exiting the editing mode 602
24.8 Apply variants to several circuits 603
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
13
Part I – Introduction
Introduction
DDS-CAD 7.3
14
Introduction Strategies for handling projects Basic functions Adjustments, extensions, configuration Index
Introduction
The model – the core of the DDS philosophy Erro
r!
X co-ordinate Z co-ordinate
Y co-ordinate Rotation
Drawing operation
Position, location
Item
Basic functions
Distribution board
Text configuration
Database
Distributions
configuration
050502 AP Distribution board 24 TE 1 pc.
configuration
UV01
UV01.1 UV01.1
Cables and lines 1x36W 1x36W
010112 PVC sheathed cable NYM 3x1.5 18.39m UV01.2
UV01.2 UV01.1
Switching and connection devices
026102 EB Ecoline series switch 1 pc.
040131 UP Schuko outlet, single 2 pc. Installation plan
extensions,
Fluorescent lamps
extensions,
Calculations
K1
Q1
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Circuit diagram
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
15
Introduction
"Model … the building blocks of models are objects that are created by only
slight abstraction processes. In the user-friendly ideal case, objects are
matched to the originals so that (ideally) they are perceived, recognised and
processed by the human consciousness."
(Brockhaus encyclopaedia, multimedial premium, 2008)
Models consist of objects. When working with DDS-CAD, the use of virtual objects
that adhere to both graphical representational and reality-based properties is typical.
In other words, a virtual object is represented in the model by a symbol, but at the
same time refers to an actual object (e.g. a lamp). This is recorded and described in
the product database.
The item is a data record. It includes the item number, a description and the
addressing for a symbol for its graphical representation. In addition, the article
Basic functions
contains the relevant technical parameters of the real object. These include – for
example, for a fluorescent lamp – the electric output, the number of bulbs and the
physical dimensions. DDS-CAD uses these parameters in its calculation routines and
for properly setting the symbol sizes.
The three-dimensional building model creates the environment for installing the
objects. For example, the room geometry is used in the lighting calculation for the
selection and design of the lamps. The objects are introduced into the model by
automatic and manual drawing operations, where the object is given position
information (consisting of coordinates). The building model also has an effect here.
So for example, the installation height of the lamps is affected by the ceiling height or
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
by a suspended ceiling.
The structures for supply and operation are also modelled: a distribution system is
defined and the symbol of its housing is placed in the model. At the same time, the
distribution board is a database in which the final circuits are developed. You select
the type of circuit and determine the connection values and DDS-CAD suggests
equipment with suitable rated values. DDS-CAD automatically calculates the power
requirements of the distribution system, which are also referred to when constructing
the main distribution board. You connect the objects to the supplying distribution
board via cables. As a result, the circuit information flows to the connected object and
appears as text information (circuit label). Step by step, the model of the system
emerges, from which all documents and reports can be derived when needed:
• Representations of the electrical installation
• Distribution board documentation
• Part lists
• Calculation logs
Index
16
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
The model – the core of the DDS philosophy Erro
r!
Product database Item: Radiator
Drawing operation
Object: Radiator
Item
Label
Attributes
Basic functions
Drawing
configuration
Part list, project "Example"
configuration
Item no. Item name Quantity
Heating – Piping
SS0912 Copper pipes, rods 5m 18x1 12.50m
Calculations SS0913 Copper pipes, rods 5m 22x1 23.85m
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
17
Introduction
Models consist of objects. When working with DDS-CAD, the use of virtual objects
that adhere to both graphical representational and reality-based properties is typical.
In other words, a virtual object is represented in the model by a symbol, but at the
same time refers to an actual object (e.g. a radiator). This is recorded and described
as an item in the product database.
Basic functions
The item is a data record. It includes the item number, a description and the
addressing for a symbol for its graphical representation. In addition, the article
contains the relevant technical parameters of the real object. These include – for
example, for a radiator – the output and the dimensions. DDS-CAD uses these
parameters in its calculation routines and for properly setting the symbol sizes.
The three-dimensional building model creates the environment for installing the
objects. You can use it to simulate the conditions of the real building and to model
the building services system. The objects are introduced into the model by automatic
and manual drawing operations, where the object is given position information
(consisting of coordinates). All input and calculated data are used continuously and
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
processed further internally. This principle can be explained using the heating system
as an example:
The structures of the building model are divided so that you can enter all data for the
heat load calculation according to DIN EN 12831. You enter the geographic location
and meteorological conditions for the building. You assign usage requirements for
the individual rooms and the physical properties for the components. DDS-CAD
calculates the standard heat load of the individual rooms and the building. The
results are used to calculate the underfloor heating and radiators. DDS-CAD designs
the heating surfaces according to the room-specific requirements and determines the
flow rates and pressure losses. These are used as input data by the pipe network
calculation.
18
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
An introduction to DDS-CAD Erro
r!
3 An introduction to DDS-CAD
Basic functions
The first time the program is launched, it automatically opens the "Start" project. You
configuration
can use this project to try out and test the software. However, it is not suitable for
configuration
editing your own projects. You will need to create and manage your own projects for
this purpose.
in the project folder. External data (such as floor plans that are sent to you) have to
Adjustments,
A project is divided into several levels and is managed through the list of drawings.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
19
Introduction
Project Menu...
(1)
(5)
type, the drawings are listed along with the following information:
takes you to the input dialogue box. To manage the global project details, click Info
(5).
The internal structure of the project is organised (with the individual application types
in mind) by assigning a three-digit drawing number (from 000 to 999). Several
number ranges are reserved within this spectrum for various purposes. DDS-CAD
therefore uses the respective number to assign the drawing to one of the following
scopes of functions and provides the necessary functions in the user interface.
2
The availability of the application types is controlled by the licence.
Index
20
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
An introduction to DDS-CAD Erro
r!
000 … 099 For modelling the storeys in the respective application type. The user
interface includes the functions of the building model and the technical
In the project structure, you must ensure the logical arrangement of the storeys. Each
storey should be considered individually and the sequence of numbers must
correspond to the actual arrangement of the storeys from bottom to top. In this case a
Basic functions
storey is classed as the parts of the building where the floor essentially forms a
common plane. In the illustrations you can see two possible examples of a building
structure, each of which represent a functional project structure:
Whereas on the
left all storeys
003 005
have the same
geometry and
are located
002
DZ 004
DZ4
003 directly above
DZ3
one another,
DZ DZ2 001
configuration
001 002 DZ1
those on the
configuration
right are offset
DZ0 DZ0 against each
000 000
other.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
21
Introduction
(2) is enabled.
Click Create (2). A query box asks
you if you want to save the current
project. A new project folder is cre-
ated in the root directory. (The il-
lustration shows part of Windows
Explorer).
Basic functions
contains too few storeys. For the following example, it is assumed that six levels in
project 1 are not sufficient. One more level needs to be created.
(1)
(4)
(2) (3)
22
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
An introduction to DDS-CAD Erro
r!
Click Add (3). The "Information for model: ..." dialogue box appears.
An existing drawing
can be removed from
the current project.
(1)
Basic functions
(4)
Files with the *.RDB extension contain the
building model of the storey. (cf. chapter 5, from
page 47).
Highlight the entry of the drawing you wish to delete and click Delete (1). The
"Delete files..." dialogue box appears. It contains a list of the files that are asso-
ciated with the drawing to be deleted.
Select the desired function (2) or (3). The entry or entries are removed from the
list. However, you can undo the operation by clicking Cancel .
configuration
If you want to remove the entry from the list of drawings, check "Delete only
configuration
the description" (4)
Click OK to perform the operation.
Note
If you only check "Delete only the description" (4) without highlighting the
extensions,
associated file with the *.BIM extension, this only removes the entry from the list of
extensions,
drawings. The drawing file is not physically deleted but only "hidden" in the list of
drawings.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
23
Introduction
All projects are created in an active root directory. You enter the path to this directory
during the installation routine. However, you can structure your project filing more
accurately by creating additional root directories and switching between them. In this
3
way, you can allocate your projects according to your own filing structure . To do this,
use the "Set Current Project Directory" function.
Basic functions
3
Create the directory structure according to your own needs, for example by the year the project started, the name of your client
or other criteria.
Index
24
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
An introduction to DDS-CAD Erro
r!
Menu bar
Execute command The message line pro- The toolbar contains general
vides information on the functions and access to the work-
Command input field ing modes (see below).
One function can be
launched per command.
The application is infre-
t
Basic functions
active working mode (see
toolbar below).
The status bar contains various information,
such as the coordinates of the cursor posi-
tions, the current layer, the object used, etc.
configuration
configuration
Project menu (page 19) Import and drawing manager (page 80)
(page 363)
Adjustments,
Working modes
The working mode is the working Text, labels
environment for a specific range of tasks. (page 488)
Switching to a different working mode
changes the content of the toolbox and
enables access to the respective
functions.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
25
Introduction
4
The drawing number is used to decide whether the current drawing is suitable, for example, for modelling a storey or for the
construction of a circuit schematic.
Index
26
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
An introduction to DDS-CAD Erro
r!
3.3.2.2 Level 2 – Models
The working model is the area of engineering activity and source of all derived
documents. Here you can visualise the initial situation (the floor plan), carry out
5
necessary demand assessments and model the building services according to your
requirements. The usual strategy here – the gradual development, assessment and
selection of different solutions – is implemented in the working model.
In the plot layout you can prepare a drawing sheet for formalised transmission. To do
6
this, you combine the drawing representations derived from the working model with
7 8 9
layout elements and explanations . However, the actual drawing output is not
connected to the use of the "plot layout" work area. If the formal layout design is
10
dispensable, you can display each presentation of the working model directly . To
build a plot layout, refer to chapter 16.3, from page 363.
A model can be presented in multiple ways. The main application of this structure
11
level is in the working model . Editing is possible everywhere, changes in one
Basic functions
presentation are automatically transferred to all other presentations. There are
essentially four types:
The "2D" presentation contains the plan view of the entire working model and uses
graphical symbols to represent the objects. On the other hand, the various views of
the 3D presentation show all objects as solid bodies.
12
A part drawing shows a defined region of the working model in plan view, using
13
graphical symbols. A section shows a defined region of the working model as a
view and represents the objects as solid bodies.
configuration
3.3.2.4 Level 4 – Views
configuration
Several views can be produced from the 3D presentations of the working model.
They are created automatically when the perspective is changed and remain saved.
To learn more about using the various perspectives and their possibilities, read
chapter 17.4, page 389.
Adjustments,
Adjustments, extensions,
extensions,
5
e.g. heat load calculation or lighting calculation
6
Summary views, part drawings (see 16.1, page 366), sections (see 16.2, page 369)
7
Sheets of different formats, title fields (see 16.3.4, page 374)
8
Legends (see 16.3.4, page 374), text (see 19.4.3, page 509)
9
on paper, as PDF or DWG/DXF file
10
see 16.4, page 377 and 16.5, page 378
11
Plot layouts can only be presented in 2D and in plan view (other representations would not make sense).
12
see 16.1, page 366
13
see 16.2, page 369
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
27
Introduction
Chapter 3.2
Page 19 Create project Chapter 5
Page 47
Chapter 4
Page 32
Apply Construct
floor plan (DWG) building model
Basic functions
Chapter 12
Create Object groups Chapter 18.2 Page 270
distribution plans Page 401
Chapter 13.2
Chapter 14 Page 307
Page 346
Draw cables and lines Chapter 13.5
Page 332
28
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Strategies for handling projects
The first step required is the creation of a project. You can then decide whether to
start editing the floor plan (grey area) or whether you simply want to develop a
The first steps in the floor plan depend on the requirements of the project. If you have
received DWG/DXF files of the floor plans, you can import these into the DDS model.
If you are working on the basis of a sketch or a printout, you can construct the floor
plan using the functions of the building model.
Once you have the finished floor plan you can get on with planning the installation
systems or installation equipment. To do this it may be necessary – even if a floor
plan is available as a DWG/DXF file – to define some or all rooms with the functions
of the building model. In the case of the lighting design in particular, a defined space
is required for the application of different functions.
You need to connect cables for a component label of the installation equipment
(circuit, distribution board), which requires that a distribution system is available. You
can create a part list at any time. DDS-CAD counts all visible objects and calculates
the drawn lengths. Similarly, you can derive a layout (sheet, with stamp, legends,
etc.) from the model at any time.
Basic functions
Planning work (lightning protection)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
29
Introduction
Designing PV systems
Strategies for handling projects
After you have created your project, you can start building it. The process for editing
a photovoltaic system (PV) essentially follows the steps below:
• Plot available area
• Design system
• Installation planning
The available area can be an open area of ground or a roof area. The description
below is based on a roof-top system. The geometric and geographic parameters of
the building must be known. Possible starting material is a building floor plan on
paper or in DWG format, which you have created on site. Basically, you can define a
roof area freely without taking into account the supporting building. However, to get a
realistic representation of the planned system, it is advantageous to model the entire
outer shell of the building.
30
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Strategies for handling projects
Heating/plumbing/ventilation
Chapter 7
Page 89 Develop building model,
Roof
Building data Walls
Heat load Ceilings
Rooms Components
Transmission Floors
heat loss Geometry Geometry
Doors/windo
Ventilation Properties Properties
heat loss
Chapter 5
Natural ventilation Page 47
Basic functions
Mechanical ventilation
configuration
configuration
Duct system
Build pipe networks
"Plumbing/heating" module
DDS-CAD 7.3
31
Introduction
When preparing a project and during the course of a project, you receive drawings
information and data to assist you in you work: floor plans, detailed plans, schematics
32
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
Basic functions
For multi-page documents, only the first page is imported.
If you need other pages, you have to save them separately. To do this, create
individual PDF files with the required pages.
configuration
geometric functions (see chapter 1, page 431). DDS-CAD detects lines and points in
configuration
the PDF file and you can use the snap functions. Finally, remove the PDF file from
the model and continue to work with the original DDS objects.
In the first two cases, proceed as with PDF files: Trace the structures required with
Adjustments,
DDS functions and then remove the image from the model. Raster images do not
contain any useful geometric information about points or lines. The snap functions
therefore do not have any effect.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
33
Introduction
Note
Basic functions
The path of the active project is displayed in the title bar (1) of the program
window.
(1)
Note
If you have replaced an existing DWG/DXF file in the project folder, the new
planning state is not yet visible in the working model. You have to activate the new
file (see 4.3.4.3, page 45).
14
For example, if you were to transfer the project folder to another computer and open the project there, the floor plans would
be missing. Instead you would see the message "Folgende Datei wurde nicht gefunden…" (The following file was not found...)
Index
34
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
4.2.2 Importing
(2)
Basic functions
(1) (3)
Select the "Import- and Model Admin" function. The "Inserted file administrator"
dialogue box appears.
Click New (1).
configuration
configuration
Select the file (2). The "Locate File” dialogue box appears.
Click OK (3). The drawing appears on the screen.
Note:
Up to this point, the procedure described above applies to any import process.
extensions,
The purpose of the operation (e.g. importing a floor plan or photo for the plot
extensions,
layout) has so far been irrelevant. In the case of a floor plan (that you intend to use
for planning) further checks and adjustments may be necessary. For more
information, please refer to the following chapter 4.3.
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
35
Introduction
• The size of the floor plan must conform to the scale of 1:1
• Each storey requires a separate drawing
• All storeys are precisely positioned on top of one another
• Remove any unnecessary information
4.3.1.1 The size of the floor plan must conform to the scale of 1:1
While modelling in DDS-CAD you work at the 1:1 scale. That means a measure in
the DDS model always matches the corresponding measure in the real world. The
default sizes of all components and objects are coordinated in this form and all
internal calculations work on this basis.
The size of the imported floor plan must therefore be checked and where necessary
corrected by a scaling factor. The operation required to do this matches all importable
file types (see 4.3.2, page 38).
Chapter 3.2.1 referred to the internal structure and the logical arrangement of the
storeys in the project. Accordingly, each project represents a building and each
drawing one storey. When transferring floor plans there are three possible options in
terms of the arrangement and distribution of the storeys.
• Each storey is supplied in a separate file
• One file contains several storeys
• One storey has been divided into several files
36
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
One file contains several storeys
Building.dwg
Basic functions
graphic you can see the split
floor plan of a ground floor. To
edit with DDS-CAD two import
Ground floor part 1
processes are necessary. The
partial floor plans must be
combined precisely and in the
correct position (cf. 4.3.3,
page 41).
configuration
configuration
4.3.1.3 All storeys are precisely positioned on top of one another
When building the network structure in a multi-storey building, vertical pipes (e.g.
pipes, cable trays, ventilation ducts) must pass from one storey to the next and
openings have to be planned. Therefore the correct position of the floor plan in the
model is absolutely crucial.
extensions,
extensions,
given.
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
37
Introduction
(title fields, legends), crop marks and much more. Many of these elements are not
needed during planning. In well-organised drawings they can simply be hidden:
Select "Find layers of lines in drawing and turn them off” function. The cursor
turns into a crosshair.
Point to an element in the drawing whose layer you would like to hide. Number
and name of the layer are displayed as information.
Click . The layer is hidden.
Click . The context menu appears and lists all hidden layers. In this way you
Basic functions
This method works for DWG/DXF files with differentiated and consistent layer
structure. In these cases, cleaning up the drawings is possible without editing in the
DWG/DXF editor. If on the other hand, there are many different object classes on a
layer or the layer structure has not been observed consistently, hiding a layer will
result in the loss of necessary information. In this situation, you should consider
editing the source file in the DWG/DXF editor (see chapter 21, page 516).
To model a system, the size of an imported floor plan must be adjusted to the actual
15
dimensions . That means an object dimensioned in the drawing must correspond
exactly to the size labelled during the review by the DDS "Measure between Two
Points” function. During the operation, first check the situation using a known
reference distance. Dimension lines or doors for example are suitable as reference
distances. If the measurement result differs from the known length, it is necessary to
determine a factor and use this to scale the floor plan. To do this, follow the steps
below:
• Measure reference distance
• Evaluate measurement result. Determine scaling factor
• Scale floor plan
15
The default sizes of all components and objects are coordinated and all internal calculations work on this basis.
Index
38
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
4.3.2.1 Measuring the reference distance
(1)
(2)
Select the "Measure between Two Points” function. The cursor turns into a
Basic functions
crosshair. The message line shows the "Locate the first point to be measured”
prompt.
Click the first end of the reference distance (1). The cursor shows the end of a
dynamic line (2).
Click the second end of the reference distance. The "Measure between Two
Points” dialogue box appears. You can evaluate the measurement result
4.3.2.2 Evaluating the measurement result and determining the scaling factor
configuration
If the measurement result is
configuration
different to the labelled
(1)
length, you have to
determine the scaling
factor. In the example, it is
clear that the floor plan is
(2)
too large by a factor of 100.
extensions,
The scaling factor is then
extensions,
Enter the measurement result, the actual length of the reference distance and
the current scaling factor (1). DDS-CAD calculates the scaling as a scale ratio
and factor (2). You can also note down the calculated value or copy it to the
Windows clipboard.
Calculated results in the Windows clipboard: Click on the (blue) text in the de-
scription field (3).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
39
Introduction
Essentially, there are two ways to carry out the size adjustment. In this case,
adjusting in the DDS model (1) is the easiest, fastest and most common option. You
alter the size of the floor plan by using the previously determined scaling factor (see
below). In some problem cases it may be necessary to edit the source file (2), if the
scaling in the DDS model is not sufficient.
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
40
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
4.3.3 Accurate placement of the storeys
Basic functions
Reference storey
The reference storey is used to check and create the position accuracy of all other
storeys. Its position is assumed to be correct.
Reference point
The reference point is a defined position, which is ideally located in the floor plans of
all storeys. For example, corners of chimneys, elevator shafts or stairwells are
suitable for this purpose. You choose the reference point yourself in terms of
suitability for purpose.
configuration
configuration
4.3.3.1 Checking position accuracy
When checking the position accuracy, you compare the positions of the floor plans in
the current storey to the reference storey. To do this, overlay the reference storey
over the model of the current storey. In the following example, the DWG/DXF import
has been completed for all storeys. The basement will serve as the reference. The
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
41
Introduction
(1)
Gro
Ba-
Gro
Ba-
Basic functions
Two operations are used to produce the correct positioning, which are useful in
different situations. You can either redefine the insertion point in the source file or
move the imported floor plan in the DDS model.
42
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
Conclusion:
Conclusion:
Use this method if you do not need to integrate into the design of other project
participants, or if you are not permitted to move the insertion point (origo).
Basic functions
(1) (2) (3)
Select the moved floor plan (in this case the ground floor) by clicking . The en-
tire floor plan is shown as a selected object.
Click . The context menu appears.
configuration
Select "Move Object(s) with Free Reference Point”. The message line shows the
configuration
"Choose Reference Point for Move” prompt.
Click on the reference point of the moved floor plan (for example, the corner of
a chimney). The entire floor plan becomes the moveable symbol.
Move the floor plan to the reference point of the reference storey (2). The point
captures the cursor and holds it tight.
extensions,
extensions,
Click . The position of the previously moved floor plan is corrected. The refer-
ence points of the two floor plans are congruent (3).
Hide the reference storey.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
43
Introduction
• Overwrite old DWG/DXF file with new file (see 4.3.4.3, page 45)
At the start of the project you have imported the first version of the floor plan as a
DWG/DXF file. The DDS model thus contains an import object, which you can edit at
any time. If a visual comparison between the old and new design state is not
necessary, we recommend that you change the reference as a practical solution.
Application
Copy the new files into the project (see 4.2.1, page 34).
Select the "Import- and Model Admin" function. The dialogue box appears.
Click on the entry of the floor plan to be replaced. The context menu appears.
Select the "Edit Properties” function. The "Locate File" dialogue box appears.
Click ... . The file selection dialogue box appears.
Select the new DWG/DXF file.
Click OK . The new floor plan appears on the screen.
Overlaying the new floor plan over the existing floor plan
makes it possible to compare two design states. The graphic
shows a suggested example. The original floor plan (grey) is
Index
44
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Import external data Erro
r!
overlaid with the newly imported floor plan (black). The different colours visualize the
differences between the two design states.
Overwriting an existing DWG/DXF file with a new file with the same name (for
example, by a copy operation in Windows Explorer) is not recommended for reasons
of data management and verification. Nevertheless, this procedure is possible.
Basic functions
However, the design stage cannot be seen immediately after the copying process.
The new file must also be enabled in the import object:
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
45
Introduction
exported.
46
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5 Building model
Building model
Chapter 5.1 Chapter 5.2 Chapter 5.3
Page 48 Page 49 Page 51
Components and
structural design
Basic functions
Requirements
graphically
configuration
Room text/
configuration
Roofs and roof structures room stamp
i Chapter 5.3.7
Dormers Roof structures Page 62
Chapter 5.4
Adjustments,
Configure
structural units Ground plan and
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
47
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.1 Components and structural design
Strategies for handling projects
The graphic shows an overview of the structural design of the building model.
Accordingly, the building (=project) is divided into storeys (=drawing). One storey can
contain several regions and each region can in turn contain several rooms. The room
is composed of the components surrounding it.
Ceiling Door
The term component
combines the surfaces
that make up a room:
Walls, floors, ceilings,
Component doors, windows and
roofs. Their properties
mainly affect the results
of the heat load
calculation.
Windows Floor Wall
Index
48
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.2 Requirements for the building model
Single region
A single region is sufficient if you only have to develop the outdoor installation of a
building. The graphical capture remains restricted to the outer building contour and
the roof. A typical example is the design of a PV system on the roof.
Individual rooms
The definition of individual rooms includes the graphical representation of room
contours, while considering the ceiling height and room designation. The method
presupposes the existence of a DWG/DXF file of the floor plan. The definition of the
region, the doors, windows and roof are omitted. This building model is sufficient for:
• Determining the building structure
• Determining room areas
Basic functions
• Inserting dynamic room texts/room stamps
• Sorting the parts list to rooms
• Transferring a room to the DIALux or Relux lighting calculation
• Installation of suspended ceilings
configuration
• The complete building structure: If the results of a heat load calculation from an
configuration
external source are available, you can apply the standard heat load of the rooms
as information in the building model. You can take this as the basis for
developing the heating system.
In this case, you enter the complete building structure with regions, rooms, doors,
windows and roofs. The thermotechnical behaviour of the components is irrelevant,
extensions,
since a heat load calculation is not required. If you have to construct the floor plan
extensions,
manually (due to a lack of DWG/DXF file), remember to take note of the wall
thickness. In this way you ensure that the floor plan conforms to the dimensions of
the original. If you can get your hands on the floor plan of an imported DWG/DXF file,
you don't have to bear the wall thickness in mind. DDS-CAD automatically makes an
adjustment.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Note:
The descriptions are based on the need to capture the floor plan in full including
consideration of the material properties.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
49
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.2.2 Requirements due to the heat load calculation
Strategies for handling projects
A complete building model with all material information is a necessary prerequisite for
a proper heat load calculation. During capture, when using doors and windows and
when drawing roofs, DDS-CAD always demands the assignment of an item from the
product database. By selecting an item you determine its physical properties and
thus the results of the heat load calculation. We can deduce a number of principles
from this fact:
• The different assignment of the item should already have taken place
when the room was defined.
In order to make the work easier and eliminate sources of error, you should
bear in mind the differentiation of the components when defining the room.
Basic functions
Assign the components with the same physical properties to the same items.
Subsequent correction of the item assignment is possible, but it means extra
work and is a source of error.
50
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Basic functions
and suspended
ceilings.
Chapter 5.3.6 Chapter 5.3.4 Chapter 5.3.5
Page 61 Page 58 Page 60
You can access the functions when you open a drawing in the "Building" (1)
application type or activate the "Use Building" working mode in other application
types (2):
configuration
configuration
(1) (2) Use Building
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
51
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.2 Capturing a region
Strategies for handling projects
5.3.2.1 Procedure
Draw contour
52
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Notes on "Close contour" and "Check settings"
If the contour is closed, DDS-CAD first asks for an item for the floor and ceiling of the
area. Once selected, the defined region is visible in the drawing with the drawn
contour (solid line) and a dashed helper line. The "Room Information" dialogue box
appears:
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
Drawn contour Helper
configuration
configuration
The settings apply by default for all rooms that are subsequently drawn in the region.
Therefore it is particularly important that the room height (1) is corrected. You can
use the description (2) to enter a name for the region. This name is used in the
various reports. The function ends when you confirm the settings with OK .
courtyard.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
53
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.2.3 Notes on buildings with different heights on one storey
Strategies for handling projects
Multi-part buildings must be divided into different regions if the height of the building
parts are different:
All three options should be considered equivalent. Select the option according to its
suitability to your needs.
You can transfer contours of rectangular rooms with doors, windows and room data
from an imported DWG DXF file. The rooms may be rectangular or trapezoidal. In
most cases, polygonal rooms must be defined manually. But even in these rooms,
you can then automatically transfer doors, windows and room data from the DWG
file.
The state of the starting material determines the effort required. In the best case, you
can capture the room contour, the doors and room data with a single click. However,
this possibility relies on the various elements being favourably positioned. It is
possible that you will need another click to transfer the room data, or you may have
to rely on a manual correction.
Index
54
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Basic functions
Starting the function
Start the “Define Rooms” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Click . The context menu appears.
Select "Recognize DDS room object from selected DWG objects”. You can apply
the function or configure it.
Use function
(1)
configuration
Room definition
configuration
Configure function
extensions,
extensions,
(2)
In the default configuration, all options for capturing DWG/DXF structures are
Adjustments,
checked. In some cases, it may be necessary to exclude certain elements from being
captured after the function is started. For example, if the room data are no longer
current, or if doors are going to be replaced, the old objects do not have to be
transferred.
Click again. The context menu lists all object classes that can be captured.
You can select each object class individually.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
55
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
Change the status of the desired object class. The context menu is closed. You
can repeat this process for other object classes.
Strategies for handling projects
Notes on doors
The function detects a door when capturing the room ("Interior Walls” object class) if
it is represented by a circular arc and opens into the captured room. The detected arc
is highlighted (2) during the operation. Other symbols are not recognised. You have
to define these doors manually (see 5.3.4, page 58).
Basic functions
Notes on windows
Windows are not captured together with the inner walls. They have to be transferred
individually after to room has been detected:
Click . A window for the building model has been defined at the position indi-
cated.
Warning
Once you have completed the operation, check the settings of all automatically
detected objects (sill height of windows, items, etc.)
Index
56
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.3.3.2 Manual graphical room capture
Define
starting point
Wall type
Basic functions
Finished?
[ESC]
configuration
progresses. DDS-CAD automatically transfers the wall types
configuration
of the outer wall and of adjacent rooms. Therefore when
moving along a "known" wall (1) during room definition, it is
(2) not necessary to select the wall type. This may only be
required again when leaving the known wall (2).
(1) extensions,
extensions,
Check the settings (see 5.4.1.3, page 74) and click OK . You can define the next
room or end the function with [ESC].
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
57
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.3.3 Capture residual area as a room
Strategies for handling projects
If an area (1) is completely bounded by adjacent rooms (2) and/or an area (3), then it
can be automatically converted into a room. Use this option to define particularly long
or complex rooms.
Start the room definition function. The
cursor turns into a crosshair.
(2
Move the cursor into the undefined area
(1).
Press [A]. The residual area is con-
(3
verted to the room. The "Room Informa-
(1 tion” dialogue box appears.
You can copy any room and paste it into the model as many times
as you wish. Use this option in floor plans with uniform sized rooms:
Basic functions
Copy room
Select a wall component of the room to be copied.
Select the "Copy Room Object..”. The cursor moves the copied
room as a dynamic symbol. You can paste the room into the
model as often as you like, but you cannot rotate it.
2nd
1st
Groun
58
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
(2) (3)
Inserting a door/window
Select the desired function. The product database is displayed.
Select the required item. The object dialogue for the door/window is displayed.
Adjust the height and sill height (2).
Fixed-width symbol
Uncheck "Get width from model” (3). Input
"Width” (1) is enabled.
Basic functions
Define the width (1) and click OK . The cursor moves the object within the
walls. You can fix it at the desired position by clicking .
configuration
Click . The cursor moves the door or window as a movable symbol with
OK
configuration
low preset width.
Move the DDS object to the corner of a symbol of the DWG/DXF file. The point
captures the cursor and holds it tight.
Click . The first corner is fixed. You can set the width dynamically.
Specify the second corner by clicking . The window or door is completed. The
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
59
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.5 Suspended ceiling
Strategies for handling projects
Grid ceiling
(1)
Basic functions
Adjust the mounting height (1) and click OK . The message line shows the
"Select a room".
Click once in the room. The suspended ceiling is oriented parallel to the refer-
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click on a handle. You can move the grid with the cursor and fix it again by
clicking .
Index
60
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.3.6 Room text/room stamp
Basic functions
Select a text configuration (1). Set the design (2).
configuration
Click OK . Depending on the selected function, room texts will automatically
configuration
appear in the centre of each room, or the cursor will move the text as a dynamic
symbol.
Editing the content of the room text
The content of a room text is controlled by the data of the room. Therefore, you have
to edit the room to update the text.
extensions,
Click in the desired room. The "Room Information” dialogue box appears.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Correct the room data (see 5.4.1.3, page 74) and click OK . The text is up-
dated.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
61
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.7 Roof areas and dormers
Strategies for handling projects
With DDS-CAD you can automatically create simple roof structures and – in the case
of complex roof structures – design individual roof areas. An automatic roof is
possible if the planned roof has a rectangular area with symmetric apex position (left
picture). Both conditions must be met, otherwise it is necessary to design separate
roof areas manually (right picture):
Conditions for automatic roof met: Conditions for automatic roof not
met. All roof surfaces have to be
designed individually:
A
A
B B
A=B
A≠B
The function draws a roof with a rectangular floor plan and symmetrical apex
position.
Select the "RoofSymbol” function. The "RoofSymbol” dialogue box is displayed:
(1)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
RoofSy
(2)
(3)
Select the desired roof shape (2). The dialogue box displays the parameters
relevant to the roof shape. For more information click Help .
Adjust all parameters. The next step depends on whether the floor plan com-
pletely is going to be fully covered with this roof, or only partially covered.
Index
62
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Complete roof covering
Basic functions
Correcting the apex position
To correct the apex position, change the rotation of the object around the Z axis by
90°:
configuration
(1
configuration
extensions,
extensions,
Adjustments,
Open the object dialogue of the roof by double clicking on it and open the
Adjustments,
"Rot./Pos.” tab.
Change the value in Input ”Around Z-axis” (1) by 90° and click OK . The dia-
logue box is closed. The apex location has been changed.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
63
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.3.7.2 Drawing roof areas manually
Strategies for handling projects
If an automatic roof is not possible, use the "Free Roof” function. Here, you draw the
outline of each separate area as a polygon. The example shows a gable roof with the
areas (1) and (2). The apex is not centred and area (2) is not rectangular:
(1)
Free roof
(2)
Basic functions
The use of the function depends partly on the particular conditions of the project (see
below), but at the same time on two specific rules, whose consequence lies in the
correct definition of the starting point. The graphic shows the location of the starting
point and the drawing direction for both roof surfaces as a black line ( ).
The conditions of the project determine how the function is used. The procedures are
described separately for:
• Manual construction based on a sketch: This situation arises for example, when
designing rooftop PV systems for an existing building. The building, especially
the geometric parameters of the roof, have bee determined on site and must be
manually transferred into the DDS model.
• Copying on the basis of a 3D DWG/DXF file: You receive a DWG/DXF file, in
which the building (especially the roof) can be seen in the 3D view.
• Copying on the basis of a 2D DWG/DXF file: You receive a DWG/DXF file, in
which the roof is only shown in the plan view as an outline.
Index
64
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Manual construction based on a sketch
[ ]
[]
[Ente
]
(3)
(4)
Basic functions
Select the "Free Roof” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Click on the starting point of the apex line (1). The cursor moves a polyline.
Press the arrow key to specify the direction of the apex line (here []). The
"Collect Points” dialogue box (2) appears.
Enter the apex length in metres (m) and click OK . The apex line is displayed
in the model.
Press the arrow key to specify the direction of the first gable edge (here []).
The "Collect Points” dialogue box appears.
configuration
configuration
Enter the length of the gable edge (3) and the roof pitch (4) and click OK . The
gable edge is displayed in the model.
Build the other roof edges.
To close the contour, press [Enter]. The "Free Roof” dialogue box appears.
Check all settings and correct the gable height in particular.
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
65
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
Copying on the basis of a 3D DWG/DXF file
Strategies for handling projects
(1)
(2)
[En-
To close the contour, press [Enter]. The "Free Roof” dialogue box appears.
Check all settings and click OK . The roof is completed and the function ends.
[En-
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
5.3.7.3 Dormers
Index
66
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Basic functions
c) e.g. if pitched roof area is present.
Select the desired shape of the dormer (3). The dialogue box displays the pa-
rameters (2) relevant to the selected dormer.
Set all parameters (2) and click OK . The dormer is moved at its outer side
(the wall) at the cursor.
configuration
configuration
Move the dormer to the desired position and click . The dormer is fixed in place
and the function ends.
Skylights
(1)
DDS-CAD 7.3
67
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
For a fixed sill height (1), enter the value and check "Lock sill height".
Strategies for handling projects
5.3.9 Gutters
You can draw gutters without an existing roof. However, it is better if the roof is
present because the corners feature a snap function to the side of the eaves:
Roof corners
Dist: 1,039, 1,089, 2,054
Roof corners
Dist: 1,039, 1,089, 2,054
Point to the first corner of the roof. The underside of the roof is detected.
Click . The "Gutter” dialogue box appears.
(2)
Gutter
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
5.3.10 Downpipe
Index
68
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
Downpipes use the polyline drawing
functions (see chapter 19.1, from
Basic functions
Downpip
configuration
configuration
Select the "Downpipes” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message
line shows the "Specify first point" prompt.
Point to the gutter. The suspended ceiling is displayed as a selected object.
Click on the position for the branch off. The downpipe begins at the gutter (1).
The cursor moves a polyline.
extensions,
In Input "Delta down” enter the value for the height difference (20 cm) and click
OK . The position of the bend (2) has been defined.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
69
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
In Input “Angle (draw dir.)” enter the angle for the direction change. All other
values are re-calculated automatically.
Strategies for handling projects
Click OK . The position of the bend (3) has been defined. The inclined portion
of the downpipe is visible in the drawing.
Press [PgDn]. The "Collect Points” dia-
logue box appears.
In Input “Absolute Z-pos.” enter the target
height for the end of the downpipe.
Click OK . The bottom end of the downpipe
has been set.
Warning!
Basic functions
When editing a multi-storey building, the ground is at a negative height from the
perspective of the attic storey. The height 0 always refers to the floor of the current
storey.
70
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.3.12 Recesses, openings
(1) (3)
(2)
WD/E/ 10x11x20
OK=12.00cm FF
Basic functions
The content in Input ”Line 1” (1) can be entered freely. The text indicates the type of
recess and the application type where necessary.
The height data (2) is formed from the mounting height and the selected reference for
its label. To do this, you may choose the finished floor level (FF), the unfinished floor
(UF) or the lower edge of the ceiling (LEC), with or without prefix. Selecting the blank
line suppresses the height data at the symbol.
configuration
Y
in the dialogue box. Please note that the
configuration
Z meaning depends on the viewing direction to
(4)
X
the opening. In the case of a wall opening (4),
the size of the opening is specified by the
17
X Y values X and Z . The value Y defines the wall
thickness. In the case of a floor opening, it is X
Z
and Y that specify the opening. The value Z
extensions,
18
(5) defines the floor thickness .
extensions,
16
Or in electrical engineering, in the "Verlegesysteme" (Installation systems) working mode
17
The observer is standing in front of the opening looking at the wall.
18
The observer is looking at the opening from above.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
71
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
Building
(2) (1)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3)
The type of use (1) affects the potable water pipe network calculation according to
DIN 1988. The peak flow is calculated according to the type of use. By selecting the
location (2) from the product database, DDS-CAD applies the standard outdoor
temperature Θe and the ground level above sea level.
The direction of north (3) is required to calculate yields for PV systems. The Polysun
Inside calculation module uses this setting to determine the orientation of the module
faces toward the Sun.
Index
72
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.4.1.2 Storey – Room overview
(1)
005
004
DZ4
003
Basic functions
DZ3
DZ2 001
002 DZ1
DZ0
000
configuration
configuration
Example
The figure shows a broken building structure. Different height levels in the building
force a project structure in which the levels 001 to 004 are offset against each other.
The height difference between the levels 002 and 003 (DZ2) should be 1.3 m.
Procedure
extensions,
Enter the value for DZ (in this case 1.3m) in Input "Storey height (from origo to
origo)” (1).
Click OK . You will be asked whether the
height should apply to all rooms.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
73
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
5.4.1.3 Room
Strategies for handling projects
Room data
(1) (2)
(3)
Basic functions
(4)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The room number (1) is generated automatically, but can be adjusted as required
(maximum length: 16 characters). DDS-CAD prevents a room number from being
used more than once. The room description (2) is initially filled from the product
database when you select a room type with … . It can also be changed as
required.
Warning
For the heat load calculation, it is not enough to just change the text in the
description. Therefore select the room type from the product database (this
stipulates room temperature and air exchange rate). Click … and adjust the
text as required.
The room height (3) is taken from the region settings. However, you can apply
separate properties for any room. The value corresponds to the distance between the
upper edge of the finished floor and the ceiling. It affects the mounting height of
lamps, air terminals and the room volume.
Index
74
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
The table (4) numbers the components surrounding the room. The component
selected in the list appears in the drawing as a selected object. Double clicking
5.4.1.4 Component
Basic functions
via the "Room Information” dialogue box (1) or by double clicking on the
component in the model (2):
(2)
configuration
configuration
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments, extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
75
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
In this case, DDS-CAD automatically creates components that use a general item (1).
However, to prepare for a heat load calculation, all components must use an item
Strategies for handling projects
Building
(2)
Basic functions
Open the “Building Information” dialogue box and select the "U-value" tab.
Select a component type from the list (1). All components of this type are shown
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
76
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.4.2 Editing the floor plan and room geometry
The geometry of the rooms and areas can be changed using the edit functions of the
polygon and/or polyline (see 19.1.8, page 459). This editing mode is turned off by
default and must be enabled.
Move node
Insert node
Basic functions
Click . The context menu appears.
In the "Advanced” sub-menu select the "Display contour as Polygon” option. The
outline of the room is displayed as a polygon with nodes and segments. For
more information on the various options, please see chapter 19.1.8, from
page 459.
Note
The option remains active and is valid for all other selected rooms and/or areas. If
at a later date this editing mode is no longer needed, you should disable it again
as a precaution. This will prevent accidental changes to the room geometry.
configuration
configuration
5.4.2.2 Dividing a room
be two rooms.
extensions,
Procedure
Adjustments,
Select the “Split Room” function. The cursor turns into a cross-
Adjustments,
Dividing a
Move the cursor to the wall where you want to start the divi-
sion. The wall is displayed as a selected object.
Click on the division point in the first wall. The cursor moves
a polyline. The message line shows the following prompt: "Set
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
77
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
path for splitting room. End by selecting a point on a wall in the room”.
Strategies for handling projects
Click on the connection point in the second wall. The room has been divided.
The function is stopped.
78
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Construct Erro
r!
5.4.2.5 Redefining the room's reference wall
Application
Basic functions
Select the desired wall (in this case wall 4) by clicking .
Click . The context menu appears.
Select the "Set Side as first in Room”. The selected wall is given the number 1.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
79
Introduction
Erro Construct
r!
You can compile all storeys of the building into a common model, or show individual
models of other application types and storeys. The main applications of this function
are varied. It can be used for example:
• To create parts lists over all storeys (see 16.5, page 369)
• For inter-floor installation
To display a different model, start the "Import- and Model Admin” in the toolbar and
then select the "Complete List of All Models in the Project” tab. This lists all the
models (storeys) of the active application type (1). Models with the symbol are
invisible. Storeys with the symbol are visible.
For a better distinction between the models shown, each of them can be assigned a
unique colour (3).
80
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Ventilation systems Erro
r!
6 Ventilation systems
In the first step you configure the ventilation system in the building model and specify
the volume flows as room data. In this way, you are preparing the layout for a
Basic functions
controlled ventilation of a residential building and the heat load calculation (see
7.3.2.2, page 97). Then you develop the ventilation system: You place the air
handling unit and the air terminals and construct the ductwork.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
81
Introduction
Building
(1)
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Open the “Building Information” dialogue box and switch to the "Air Flow Re-
quirements" tab.
Select the ventilation system (1).
Enter the temperature of the supply air (2) and the building-related minimum air
exchange (3).
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. You can configure the rooms.
Index
82
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Ventilation systems Erro
r!
6.1.2 Check and correct room data
Room In-
(1)
Basic functions
(2)
(3)
configuration
configuration
Select the "Room Information” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The
message line shows the “Point to the room you want to edit” prompt.
Click in the room whose ventilation data you want to adjust. The "Room Infor-
mation” dialogue box is displayed.
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
83
Introduction
first balance the air volumes. In this way, the volume flows of the rooms are
equalised with each other within a given tolerance.
You can have the calculated volume flows displayed in the room label in the model.
Afterwards, select the air terminals and place them in the rooms. Finally, check the
capacity of the air terminals by carrying out a new calculation.
Building
steps.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
Step 1
DDS-CAD calculates the volume flow of a room based on the minimum air exchange
and calculates the sum of the volume flows for supply and exhaust air.
Step 2
DDS-CAD increases the lower volume flow to the higher value. The difference (e.g.
the additional supply air) is divided among the other fresh air rooms. In doing so, the
program checks whether the maximum values of the individual rooms are reached.
Step 3
DDS-CAD checks whether the total air exchange in the building is achieved and
whether in doing so the maximum values for air exchange in the individual rooms are
reached.
Index
84
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Ventilation systems Erro
r!
The verification of the maximum values and the total air exchange in the building may
result in information that DDS-CAD displays in an information list, where necessary.
Note:
In the worst cases, the air volumes can only be balanced with difficulty. For
smaller systems (in detached and semi-detached houses) you can check
"Balance between storeys). In this case, it is easier to achieve a balance of the
volume flows between fresh air and exhaust air rooms.
Basic functions
The next step is to place the air terminals (see 6.2.2, page Error! Bookmark not
defined.). Then carry out a new calculation to check their capacity.
configuration
(1) volume balancing are repeated.
configuration
In addition, the air volume of
each room is distributed to the
installed air terminals.
The information
list reports all
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
85
Introduction
You can also expand the product database and create your own
items (see 22.2.3, page 538). In terms of symbols used, you can
refer to external data in the DWG/DXF (see 23.3, page 575) and
3DS formats (see 23.4, page 576).
(2)
(1)
Application
Select the “Air Terminal” function. The “Air Terminal” dialogue box appears.
Select an item (1).
Adjust the mounting height and mount type (2).
Click OK . The cursor moves the symbol.
Index
86
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Ventilation systems Erro
r!
Basic functions
(3)
(4)
(5)
configuration
6.2.3 Substitute object for simulating sub-networks/consumers
configuration
6.2.3.1 Introduction
ventilation system without fully constructing the system in DDS-CAD. For example,
extensions,
you can collect the volume flows of part of a building in an object in order to allow a
short-term calculation of the main pipe sections.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
87
Introduction
88
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7 Heat load calculation
A heat load calculation with DDS-CAD requires the building model (see chapter 5)
and – in the case of a planned ventilation system – the rooms' volume flows entered
and balanced in the DDS ventilation module (see chapter 6.1.3.1, page 84). The
following graphic shows the general procedure prescribed by the DIN standard on the
left and, on the right, the necessary operations in DDS-CAD:
Basic functions
Heat load calculation according to Operations in DDS-CAD
DIN EN 12831
Determine meteorological data Design ventilation system
configuration
configuration
Calculate ventilation heat loss Perform calculation
Chapter 7
Calculate total heat load Page 89
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
The effort for a calculation is always determined by the current starting position and
the available data. Therefore the following chapter describes some conceivable
situations. The various strategies for processing the project with DDS-CAD are
derived from this. Afterwards there are notes on the important settings for achieving
an accurate calculation result.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
89
Introduction
Different situations can arise considering the available starting data and the data to
be found. Please note that there may be some overlapping in the project:
Chapter 7.3
Check and correct components Page 94 Perform calculation
U-values
Yes Chapter 7.4.3
U-value Page 111
Enter
known?
No Chapter 8
Calculate Chapter 7.4.2.3 Page 119
Page 108
Perform calculation
Place heating surfaces
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Underfloor heating
Print results
Chapter 7.5
Page 117 Radiator
In most cases, there are no reliable data about the standard heat load of the rooms.
These data therefore have to be calculated. A decisive parameter is the heat transfer
coefficient of the components (U-value). Known U-values can be entered directly.
Unknown U-values have to be calculated. Here, the composition of a component is
structured in tabular form and the U-value is updated at the same time. In rare cases,
you can refer to a documented heat load calculation and transfer the data into the
building model manually.
90
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.2 Checking and correcting building data
Building
(5)
(6)
Basic functions
(7)
(8)
configuration
the height above sea level (7)
configuration
from the product database. You
can change these values
manually if necessary.
Height above
To start with, the value for
ΔZ Input "Base height” (8) is
extensions,
NN = 0
above sea level” (7). If the two
values match, this corresponds
to a building with a floor slab on
the ground. If the building is partially recessed into the ground, reduce the value in
Input " Base height” (8). The difference between the two values corresponds to the
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD automatically defines the component position of the outer walls in the
basement storeys ("against outside air" or "against soil"). If the exterior walls are
more than 2/3 in the ground according to ΔZ, all exterior walls of the basements are
calculated "against soil". On the other hand, if the proportion in the soil is low, the
calculation is made "against outside air".
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
91
Introduction
(1)
(2) (8)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(9)
Basic functions
(6)
(7)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1) The values for the temperature Θe and the mean annual temperature Θm,e (1) are
transferred from the general settings as meteorological data.
(2) You must always check the groundwater depth and adjust to the prevailing local
conditions.
Note
If the distance between the floor slab and the water table is less than 3m, the
calculation of the transmission heat requirement will consider all components in
contact with the soil with the correction factor GW of 1.15 (see
DIN EN 12831 Supp. 1; section 3.4.3).
(3) The building location e (shielding coefficient) affects the ventilation heat loss. The
value depends on the shielding class and the number of exterior walls exposed to the
wind. You can configure the shielding class. DDS-CAD determines the number of
exterior walls "against outside air" and selects the required value.
(4) The air tightness of the building shell n50 is the parameter for determining the
natural infiltration. Wind flow and temperature differences cause a pressure
difference between the interior and the exterior of the building. This results in an
Index
92
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
exchange of air, which takes place thanks to gaps (e.g. windows) in the building
shell.
(5) The building mass affects the heat storage capacity Ceff and thus the calculated
result of the reheating energy ΦRH (with intermittent heating mode). The DIN standard
refers to two levels for light and medium duty and/or heavy duty construction.
(6) Thermal bridges such as window lintels, window sills etc. affect the U-value of a
component and thus the transmission heat loss through the component. Their
influence therefore needs to be considered in the heat load calculation. In
"Consider thermal bridges ΔUWB" select how this should be considered:
Setting Meaning
Without on-site DDS-CAD applies a flat-rate factor of 0.1 to the building. It is
Basic functions
consideration assumed that the structural design of thermal bridges has been
carried out without special thermal protection measures.
With on-site DDS-CAD applies a flat-rate factor of 0.05 to the entire building.
consideration It is assumed that the structural design of thermal bridges has
been carried out to DIN 4108 Supplement 2.
Detailed evidence The heat load calculation is carried out in detail, taking into
account each individual thermal bridge in the building. This
setting requires that all thermal bridges have been introduced in
the building model (see 7.4.4, page 116).
(7) Options opens a dialogue box for default settings. You can select the international
configuration
version of DIN EN 12831 (8) and modify the temperature of the reverse of internal
configuration
walls globally if no room has been defined there (9). This situation arises during the
graphical room capture along chimneys and shafts.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
93
Introduction
94
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.3.2 Notes on the ventilation heat loss ΦV
Note:
To accurately determine the ventilation heat loss in buildings with mechanical
ventilation, you need the DDS ventilation module, including the "Kontrollierte
Wohnraumlüftung" (Controlled ventilation of residential buildings) module. If these
modules are not contained in your licence, DDS-CAD always assumes that the
ventilation is natural ventilation.
Basic functions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
95
Introduction
The calculation with natural ventilation compares the influences of natural infiltration
and the hygienic minimum air volume flow:
symbol
inf,ie Natural infiltration (=air tightness of the building shell n50)
Wind flow and temperature differences cause pressure from outside on the
building. This cold outside air enters through permeable joints (e.g. windows)
and must be heated up. To calculate the natural infiltration:
Define the air-tightness of the building shell (n50), see 7.2.2, page 92.
96
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.3.2.2 Mechanical ventilation
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
(3)
(5)
(4)
Warning! configuration
configuration
After changing the ventilation parameters in the building or room dialogue
ALWAYS calculate the volume flows. Only then do the changed settings take
extensions,
effect in the heat load calculation. To do this, click Calculate in the Building
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
97
Introduction
building. This cold outside air enters through permeable joints (e.g. windows)
and must be heated up. The heat loss through natural infiltration is known as
ΦV,inf,i (1). To calculate the natural infiltration:
Define the air-tightness of the building shell (n50), see 7.2.2, page 92.
Adjust the volume flow and the temperature of the supply air in the DDS
ventilation module. See above.
98
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
Basic functions
Select "bu" (3). An input field for bu is displayed
(4).
Enter the numerical factor or click … (4) to se-
lect a standard value.
(3)
(4)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
99
Introduction
Measure rooms
separately
Basic functions
Calculate rooms
separately
1st floor
Ground floor
100
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.3.5 Global settings for all rooms
Building
Basic functions
(1)
configuration
Open the Building Information dialogue box and switch to the "Heat Load” tab.
configuration
Click Set all . The "Set all” dialogue box appears.
Click the option for the desired processing step.
Configure the associated parameters.
Click OK . The configuration is applied to all rooms in the building model.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
101
Introduction
Outside air
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The dimensions of a component are defined when constructing the building model as
described in chapter 5 (from page 47) by corresponding drawing operations. It is an
individual property of each individual component in the building. Component type and
position code are discussed in the following sections.
Index
102
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.4.1.1 Component type
(1) (2)
A component's U-value (2) is always directly linked to the item (1). To start with, it is
taken from the item (e.g. AW54) when constructing the building model, but must be
Basic functions
corrected by manual input or calculation before the heat load calculation takes place
(see 7.4.2, page 105). You can see an overview of all component types in the
building model in the Building Information dialogue, under the "U-Value” tab:
Building
Adjustments, extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
The term "component type" can be differentiated by the various component groups
Adjustments,
(wall, floor, ceiling, etc.). In this case we talk about wall types, floor types, ceiling
types, etc.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
103
Introduction
The position code is an individual property of the separate component and describes
the situation on its reverse. According to DIN EN 12831, a component can be
directed against outside air, heated and unheated rooms and against soil. The
calculation algorithm for heat loss depends on that accordingly.
The status – calculated automatically (3) or selected manually (4) is shown under the
"Heat Load” tab of the component dialogue. The example (below) shows that the
position code of this exterior wall is set to "Calculated”. In addition, the calculated
Basic functions
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(4)
(5)
Index
104
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.4.2 The heat transfer coefficient (U-value)
The U-value describes the heat loss of a component type based on its material
composition and the temperature difference between front and back in watts per
square meter and Kelvin (W/m²⋅K).
If the U-values used in the project are known, a calculation is no longer necessary
and you can enter the values manually. If the components' U-values are not know,
then they must be calculated. The composition of a component (the layering) is
structured in tabular form. There are two ways to adjust the U-values:
• Overview of the U-values in the Building Information dialogue
• "U-value" tab in the dialogue of a specific component
Basic functions
Building
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
If the U-value = 0, this component type is not included in the heat load calculation.
This may be a default or an error. To edit the U-value of a component type:
Select the entry by clicking . The context menu appears.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
105
Introduction
106
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.4.2.2 Assigning known U-value manually
Warning!
This method is not possible for floors with underfloor heating. For these floors, a
layering arrangement has to be built up and the position of the heat pipe defined
(see below).
(1) (2)
Basic functions
(3)
Application
configuration
configuration
Click Manual (1). The "Manual U-Value” dialogue box appears.
Enter the U-value and density.
Click OK . The list (2) displays information on a manually entered U-value. The
new values are displayed (3)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
107
Introduction
If the U-value of a component is not known, you must determine this by calculation.
To do this, construct the component in layers from inside to outside. Using the
material properties of each individual layer, DDS-CAD calculates the resulting U-
value, the density and the dew point on the surface of the component.
At the same, the software has to differentiate between composite and non-composite
components:
108
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
Application – constructing the layering:
(5)
(2) (3)
Basic functions
(1)
(4)
configuration
configuration
Repeat the procedure until the layering of the area segment is complete.
For a composite component, build any other area segments in the same way
until the sum of the area segments is 100%.
extensions,
Check the settings of the interior and exterior heat transfer resistances Rsi/Rse
extensions,
(5) and click OK . The calculated U-value now applies to all components of the
project that are associated with this item.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
109
Introduction
You can edit the layering of a component later. This means you can move their
position in the table (6), use the context menu (7) to modify their properties or delete
the layer.
(7)
(6)
(7)
Basic functions
Note
When you select an item for the floor, you can use the "component" filter to see
the layerings prepared according to DIN EN 1264 Part 4.
Index
110
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.4.3 Notes on the position code (reverse of the component)
In order to calculate the heat load of a room correctly, the situation at the reverse of
the component must be determined. During the graphical capture of the areas and
rooms, DDS-CAD: already detects for example, whether there is a heated or
unheated room at the reverse of a wall and which temperatures prevail there.
Sometimes it may be necessary to bypass the automated results and define the
position code manually:
Basic functions
Example 2 – Single storey
You are editing a single storey in a large building. The
adjacent floors (1) are not part of your remit. In this
case it is sufficient to only capture the relevant storey in
(1) the building model. However, you have to check and
correct the position code of the ceiling and the floor (2).
(2)
(1)
against the soil, while the other exterior walls border the
extensions,
(1) outside air. In this case too, you have to check the
position code of the exterior walls and divide them
where necessary (see 5.4.2.3, page 78).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
For more information on components in contact with the soil, please refer 7.4.3.4,
page 114.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
111
Introduction
(1)
112
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
7.4.3.3 Resetting manual changes to the position code
Building
Basic functions
(1)
Open the building information dialogue box and switch to the "Heat Load” tab.
Click Set all . The "Sett all” dialogue box appears.
configuration
configuration
Select "from manual to calculated position code”.
Click OK . The position code has been set to "calculated" for all components in
the model.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
113
Introduction
DDS-CAD automatically sets the floor of the lowest storey "against soil". The same
applies to the exterior walls if the building is sunken into the ground. This setting is
configured in the Building Information dialogue (see 7.2.1, page 91).
properties of a floor panel must be corrected for this. The resulting value (Uequiv) is
ultimately used to calculate the transmission heat loss of components in contact with
soil. DDS-CAD determines Uequiv according to DIN EN 12831, from tables 4 to 7. The
following example shows an excerpt from table 4:
114
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
The component dialogue of a floor in contact with soil displays all relevant data.
Basic functions
The U-value of the component (1) can be entered manually or calculated precisely by
constructing the layering (see 7.4.2, page 105). The value B' (2) results from the ratio
between the observed area of the floor panel (3) and half of its circumference (4).
configuration
configuration
The value of B' can only be calculated precisely for a single room if it is directly
connected to the exterior wall. For interior rooms (without exterior wall) B' is
calculated for the entire building and transferred to the room.
The corrected U-value Uequiv (5) is interpolated with values and intermediate values
from the DIN standard tables.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
115
Introduction
If thermal bridges (e.g.window lintels, window sills, etc.) considered in detail, first
check the configuration of the heat load calculation in the Building Information
dialogue (see 7.2.2, page 92). Next, you have to add the relevant components – in
the case of a window. To do this, use the list of components in the "Room
Information” dialogue:
Room Inform
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(4)
Select the component to which you want to assign the thermal bridge (1).
Select the "thermal bridge" component type in the drop-down list (2).
Click Add (3). The product database is displayed.
Select the desired item. The "Thermal bridge” dialogue box appears.
Check the length (4) and click OK . The thermal bridge has been inserted into
the list of components and can be used in the calculation.
Index
116
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heat load calculation Erro
r!
Warning!
Modified settings are only considered in the results and the printouts after
performing the calculation. Therefore, you must repeat the calculation after
changing a setting.
Basic functions
(2)
DDS-CAD 7.3
117
Introduction
Click . The print preview is displayed: You can print the document.
118
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8 Heating and sanitary facilities
After starting one of these functions (e.g. the basin) the product database is
displayed. You select the required object as an item from here. Then you are taken to
the object dialogue, where you can make other settings. After confirming with OK
the cursor moves the symbol of the object. You can place this in the model as many
times as you need.
Basic functions
Default
configuration
(1)
configuration
(2)
extensions,
extensions,
Valve
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
All objects have insert points for media lines. Their technical parameters (e.g. flow
pressure, flow rate, etc.) are stored in the item and are evaluated by the calculation
after connection to the pipe network. The functions of the lower area (2) are always
related to the structure of a pipe network and are linked to this.
19
Substitute objects for the simulation of consumers and sub-networks are excluded (see 8.1.2, page 123)
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
119
Introduction
sub-networks/consumers
8.1.2.1 Introduction
20
Technical details for individual objects are generally not included in DWG files (cf. 4.1.1, page 34)
Index
120
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.1.2.3 Configuring a substitute object for potable water consumers
Basic functions
Enter the length (3) of the symbol in millimetres (mm).
configuration
pipelines into the right position. The
configuration
result of the settings appears in a
preview.
Observe the system data settings (2).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
121
Introduction
With DDS-CAD you can design radiators and underfloor heating. It may be that the
heat load of a room is not going to be provided by a single heating facility (radiator
OR underfloor heating), but is to be provided by a combination of several heating
systems. In this case, you can distribute a room's heat load to multiple facilities and
optimise their dimensioning. In addition to underfloor heating and radiators, further
heating facilities can be taken into account, but not be dimensioned by an internal
calculation.
122
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.2.1 Specifying the building standard and adjusting a storey
Building
(3)
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
Select the "Building Information” function. The "Building Information” dialogue
box appears.
Switch to the "Heating Facilities” tab.
Define the proportion (2) of the heat load (1) that can be apportioned to the heat-
ing facilities.
configuration
Click Set The settings are transferred to all rooms in the building. Subse-
configuration
quently, you can adjust each storey and each separate room.
If the heating facilities of an entire floor differ from the building standard, adjust the
storey settings:
Select the "Building Information” functions and switch to the "Heating Facilities”
tab.
Click Set curr. . The settings are transferred to all rooms of the current storey.
Subsequently, you can adjust each separate room.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
123
Introduction
If the heating facilities of individual rooms differ from the building standard, adjust the
settings of these rooms:
Room data
displayed.
Switch to the "Heating Fa-
cilities” tab.
Adjust the settings of the
heating facilities. Define the
proportion of the heat load
(1) that can be apportioned
to the heating facilities, ei-
ther as a percentage (2) or
(1) (2) (3) (4) in absolute terms (3).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The detailed method allows the calculation and documentation of the system
(according to DIN EN 1264). It provides technical building requirements, which must
be considered when constructing the building model and when calculating the heat
load.
Index
124
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
The simplified method is the quick way to graphic representation. The graphic shows
the process at a glance. If you choose the simplified method, you can jump directly to
Detailed method:
Requirements
Design underfloor heating Chapter
Flooring construction 7.4.2.3
Building technical Position of the heating tube Page 108
requirements
Chapter 7
Heat load calculation Page 89
Select manufacturer
and system Adjust heating Chapter 8.2
facilities Page 122
Basic functions
Calculate and Check basic settings
optimise system Chapter 8.3.5 for drawing
Page 130
configuration
Chapter 8.3.7 Draw underfloor heating
configuration
Page 144
At the beginning of the detailed method, select the manufacturer of the system
extensions,
components and a product. Then define the heating region distributor and draw the
extensions,
heating regions. Use the calculation to size and optimise the system and prepare the
output of the calculation results.
The general part list includes distributor and heat pipe, but no system plates or
Adjustments,
insulating materials. Use the underfloor heating print function to enter these (see
8.3.7, page 144).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
125
Introduction
Heating region distributor and heating regions are managed in the Building
Information dialogue under the "Underfloor Heating” tab. The upper table contains
the heating region distributor. The lower table lists all heating regions in the project –
each with their technical parameters. Clicking on a row in the table opens a context
menu with functions for editing.
Building
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
(3)
(4)
(5)
The upper area is where you define the manufacturer (1). The underfloor heating
system must be developed with actual system components (see 8.3.3, page 128).
New (2) creates a new heating region distributor (see 8.3.4, page 129). Heating
region distributors are a prerequisite for the subsequent calculation, but not for
building the heating regions. You can change the configuration of the system as
desired (see 8.3.4, page 129).
Find by pointing (3) is a navigational aid to quickly get to the calculation results of an
object you are interested in. After being opened, the dialogue box is invisible and you
can select the heating region distributor and/or the heating in the model by clicking
. The management dialogue box reappears when the corresponding row is selected.
Use the scroll bars or the zoom function (4) to view the table.
Draw Cut out Split into (5) are used to construct the heating regions (see 8.3.5,
page 130).
Options (6) configures the basic settings for drawing and calculating the heating
regions. In this way, you choose between the detailed or simplified method.
Calculate (7) starts the calculation routine.
Print (8) starts the output of the calculation results (see 8.4.5, page 154).
Index
126
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
Information in the heating region table
Basic functions
Flow, l/h Volume flow in the heating region
Pr. drop, Pa Pressure loss of the heating region Red Maximum pressure loss
exceeded
Spec output, W/m² Specific power Red No power in the heating system
(see 8.2.2, page 124)
Output, W Output Red Actual output<target output or no
output specified in the system
Calc. Surf. temp., °C Calculated surface temperature Red Maximum surface temperature
exceeded
configuration
Supply temp., °C Flow temperature Red Flow temperature > 100°C
configuration
Return temp., °C Return temperature
Pipe pr. drop, Pa Pressure loss across the heat pipe
Kv, m³/h Kv value
Max. pipe length, m Maximum pipe length
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
127
Introduction
(3)
(1)
(4)
(2)
Basic functions
Click (1). The “Select Manufacturer Database(s)” dialogue box appears. This
lists the data records of all available manufacturers.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Enable the manufacturer required by Activate (2) or double clicking . The "X"
character is displayed in front of the row. Activate is blocked. The data record is
used in the project and cannot be turned back off.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed.
Click … (3). The product database shows the selected manufacturers along
with their systems.
Select the manufacturer and the system of the underfloor heating. The product
database disappears. You will be asked whether the system should be used for
all rooms.
Click Yes . The system appears in Display " Manufacturer” (4).
Note:
The prompt "Use the selected manufacturer/type in all rooms?" is only relevant for
subsequently exchanging a system of an existing facility.
Index
128
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.3.4 Selecting and placing the heating region distributor
(3)
Basic functions
(1) (2)
configuration
configuration
Click New (1). The product database is displayed and lists the heating region
distributors of the previously selected manufacturer.
Select the required item. The product database disappears. The "Distributor” dia-
logue box appears.
extensions,
Check the installation height (2) and click OK . The cursor moves the heating
extensions,
Note:
You can view and edit each entry via a context menu (see 8.3.2, page 126).
Similarly, you can also delete, move or modify the distributors directly in the
model.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
129
Introduction
8.3.5.1 Introduction
All heating regions are listed in the Building Information dialogue in a table and are
21
represented in the model by shaded polygons . The shape of a heating region can
automatically be adjusted to the room or be drawn manually. In this way, you can edit
several rooms in one step. DDS-CAD automatically splits the heating regions at the
room boundaries. The colour of the polygon shows
the status of the heating region (3):
• Not heated: Green
• Normal temperature: Blue
• Higher temperature: Red
Move node
Basic functions
(1)
(2) (3)
(4)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(5)
(6)
The position in the building (1) is indicated along with the numbers of the storey, the
region and the room as well as the room name. Furthermore, each heating region
contains a consecutive distributor-related number (2).
From the heating region you can access the properties of the floor (5), in which the
heat pipe is embedded. Please note that a change will affect all floors of the same
21
Unheated areas (2) are not shown in the table.
Index
130
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
floor type (see 7.4.1, page 102). The item (6) used and the calculated results (7) of
the region are displayed in the lower part of the dialogue box.
You have to check two basic settings for the definition of heating regions. Click Options
(1). In the "Options” dialogue box, specify the distance to the wall (2) and adjust the
consideration of the heat load (3):
Basic functions
(1) (2) (3)
configuration
distance (2) set between the heating region and the walls is maintained.
configuration
"Allow rooms without underfloor heat load or pipe” (3)
By default, heating regions are defined to
dimension underfloor heating. DDS-CAD
automatically checks compliance with the
building's technical requirements. If these are not
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
131
Introduction
The definition and editing of heating regions are also started from the Building
Information dialogue:
(4)
Draw (1)
The function creates new heating regions and edits existing ones. After calling the
function, you can choose from the context menu whether existing heating regions are
drawn over, connected to each other, or whether the remaining area of the room
should be filled with new heating regions. The drawing application is equal to working
with the polygon (see 19.1, page 432). You can also use specific auxiliary functions
(see below). A new heating region is always assigned to the active distributor (4).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
You can change this assignment later (see 8.3.5.1, page 130).
The function is only used to reduce existing heating regions. In this way you can, for
example, consider storage spaces, pillars and stair openings. The drawing
application is again equal to working with the polygon (see 19.1, page 432).
You can manually split existing heating regions into equal-sized sub-areas (see
page 137).
The following pages contain an overview of the various operations and descriptions
of their respective procedures.
Index
132
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
Basic functions
Automatic heating region in a room page 13
A single room is to be completely covered by a heating 5
region.
configuration
Draw over heating region page 13
configuration
When drawing a heating region, there may 6
be overlap with existing ones. The areas
covered are cut from the existing region.
DDS-CAD 7.3
133
Introduction
Procedure
Check the settings and click OK . The dialogue box is closed. The function remains
active.
Rectangle:
(2)
[Enter]
(1)
[Enter]
134
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
Procedure
[Enter]
Basic functions
Click . The context menu appears.
Select the "Overwrite” function. The context menu is closed.
Press [Enter]. The room gets a heating region. The "Underfloor Heating Region”
dialogue box appears.
Check the settings and click OK . The function remains active.
configuration
Parts of a room have been covered with one or
configuration
more heating regions. The remaining area is to
be filled automatically by additional heating re-
gions.
Procedure
extensions,
extensions,
[Enter]
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
135
Introduction
Procedure
[En-
Example
Procedure
[En-
136
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
Split heating regions
Procedure
A0 A1 A2 A3
Basic functions
Enter the desired number of sub-areas.
Click Split into . The dialogue box is closed. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Click on the heating region to be divided. The heating region is separated into the
specified number of sub-areas. All sub-areas are the same size. The function remains
active.
configuration
configuration
Example
Procedure
remains active.
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
137
Introduction
The calculation function dimensions the heating regions defined in the building
according to DIN EN 1264. The calculated results of the heating regions and heating
region distributors are shown in dialogues, and output in calculation logs. The
pressure losses of the heating region distributors are transferred to the heating pipe
network calculation, where the hydraulic balancing of the distribution valves takes
place (see 10, page 215).
DDS-CAD proceeds room by room during the calculation, whereby first the least
favourable room with the highest specific heat loss (W/m²) is considered. For the
heating regions, the ideal distances of the heat pipes are determined. Pressure loss
and pipe length are monitored. Exceeding these parameters will automatically divide
the regions. You can configure the division.
If the room has separate heating regions for higher and normal temperatures, the
higher temperature regions will be examined first. Their surface temperature must be
higher than that of the normal temperature region (cf. 8.3.5.1, page 130). Therefore
you can apply more output to the room, without exceeding the limit and unloading the
normal temperature region. Based on this assumption, the aim for the higher
Basic functions
temperature regions is the smallest possible pipe-to-pipe distance that does not
exceed the maximum surface temperature. When dimensioning normal temperature
regions on the other hand, the aim is to achieve the largest possible pipe-to-pipe
distance, which is necessary to cover the calculated heat load.
138
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.3.6.1 Setting global calculation parameters
Basic functions
(1)
configuration
The calculation monitors the pipe length of the individual heating regions and the
configuration
respective pressure loss. After you have defined the settings, DDS-CAD
automatically separates a heating region:
• (4) if the max. pipe pressure drop is exceeded
• (5) if the pressure loss or the pipe length are exceeded
• (6) if the max. pipe length is exceeded
•
extensions,
(7) if exceeded values are ignored, heating regions are not split.
extensions,
compares the resulting value to the defined lower limit. The calculation always
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
139
Introduction
(3)
(4)
Basic functions
Manufacturer/System (2)
The system components are determined globally in the Building Information dialogue
and transferred to the individual rooms (see 8.3.3, page 128). If you want to make a
different rule for individual rooms, check "Overwrite the global manufacturer” and
select the desired product.
140
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
The smaller the pipe-to-pipe distance, the greater the power output and the
Basic functions
For optimisation, you can set this
maximum possible actual output
as the new target output for the
underfloor heating (4).
configuration
Compensate for the missing
configuration
portion with another heating
facility.
heating is present).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
141
Introduction
You can start the calculation process from the Building Information dialogue or from
the "Room Information” dialogue. In both cases, the entire building is calculated.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click Calculate . The algorithm starts. The calculated results appear in the tables of
the Building Information dialogue and the room data. If necessary, an information
list is also displayed. This lists errors and provides warnings and information.
If necessary, optimise the system and repeat the calculation. In doing so, please
refer to the notes of the information list (see below).
Index
142
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
Working with the information list
Possible messages, their meanings and options for remedying the cause
Basic functions
divided into more than n parts. Insert more Splitting heating region manually
distributors or split manually." Page 137
"Warning: This zone cannot be calculated Setting the pipe-to-pipe distance
because the required heat load is already Page 140
covered by the higher temperature zone.
Manually set higher temperature zone to a
larger pipe-to-pipe distance."
"The floor in this room has no underfloor Position of the heat pipe Page 110
heating pipe. Define the position of the pipe
in the U-value calculation."
"The actual output x W of this room is
configuration
smaller than the target output y W. Install
configuration
radiators."
"The surface temperature of x°C of this Flow/return temperature Page 139
heating region is greater than the permitted Room temperature Page 94
maximum of y°C. Correct flow, return, or Pipe-to-pipe distance Page 140
room temperature or set larger pipe-to-pipe
distance."
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
143
Introduction
You can print out the calculation log to evaluate the underfloor heating. Start the print
function in the Building Information dialogue or in the "Room Information” dialogue:
Basic functions
Report Contents
HU_Underfloorheating_report_EN_1264.rpt You receive a report on the underfloor
heating calculation according to
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
EN 1264. It contains
• Cover page
• Evidence of the heat balance
• Room list with list of the heating re-
gions
• List of the heating regions by dis-
tributors (sorted by pressure loss)
Warning!
The general part list includes
distributors and heat pipes, but no
system plates or insulating materials.
Use this report for a complete part list
for the underfloor heating.
Index
144
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.3.8 Labelling heating regions
Part Text
(2)
Basic functions
(1)
region and displays the name and the technical parameters in the text.
Adjustments,
Fix the text symbol at the desired position by clicking . The function remains
active. You can label further heating regions.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
145
Introduction
8.4.1 Introduction
With DDS-CAD you can design new heating facilities and simulate existing facilities.
In both cases, you have to rely on the use of actual product data. Dimensions and
output are the relevant design parameters. Output, water quantity and pressure loss
are required for the pipe network calculation.
Use the "Hersteller Datenbank laden" (Load manufacturers database) function to call
the product data (see 22.2.5, page 544). You can then insert and dimension radiators
in the model through an automatic selection. Any necessary corrections to the
positions and/or the properties of individual radiators are carried out manually.
This chapter first describes the properties of a single radiator and then the
management function for radiators in the Building Information dialogue. Using this
function, you can design radiators according to the following diagram:
Plan radiator
Requirements
Basic functions
Replace
existing
Button [Calculation] Lock radiator
Install
additional
No
OK? Change
Y position
Print
calculation results Chapter 8.4.4 Chapter 8.4.3.3
Page 151 Page 150
Index
146
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.4.2 Radiators
(2)
Heating/Coo
(1)
(3)
(4)
Load
manufacturers
d b
Basic functions
Application
Select the "Heating/Cooling Equipment” function. The product database shows
the preloaded product data of the radiator manufacturer.
Select the item. The "Heating/Cooling Equipment” dialogue box shows the di-
mensions (1). To start with, standard items are chosen for the radiator valve and
the lock shield valve (2). You can also use real product data.
configuration
Enter the desired installation height (3). The lower edge of the radiator is used as
configuration
the reference.
For wall mounting with the symbol function [Ctrl]+[D] (see page 405) define
the distance to the wall (4).
Click OK . The cursor moves the radiator symbol.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
147
Introduction
logue
8.4.3.1 General overview
Building
Find by pointing (4) is a navigational aid to quickly get to the calculation results of an
object you are interested in. After opening the function, the dialogue box is invisible
and you can select the object in the model by clicking . This will take you back into
the calculation dialogue, where the corresponding row is highlighted.
Options (5) configures the calculation. You specify the parameters for automatic
Print (7) allows the output of the calculation results in various reports (see 8.4.5,
page 154).
Index
148
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.4.3.2 Information in the radiator list
Basic functions
% Ratio between actual and target output as a percentage (%).
Dimensioned The radiator has not been calculated or is no longer up-to-date.
The radiator has been calculated. The text colour indicates the
status of the parameter, i.e. the success of the design (see
below).
Manufacturer Name of the radiator manufacturer.
Type
Return temp. °C Calculated return temperature under the set conditions.
ID
configuration
configuration
Phi_HL,Ausl,b,i W Designed heat load of the heated room in watts (W):
Sum of transmission and ventilation heat losses and the heat-up load
of the room (to compensate for the effects of intermittent heating).
Room target Standard heat load of the heated room in watts (W):
output, W Sum of transmission and ventilation heat losses
Room actual Output of the installed radiator actually provided
extensions,
output, W
extensions,
Orange The parameter is outside the set tolerances (see 8.4.4.3, page 152).
Blue The radiator cannot be changed by the calculation. It has been manually fixed or
does not originate from a manufacturers database.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
149
Introduction
Add new
The function inserts a new radiator into the list. After calling the function, the " Room
selection” dialogue box is displayed:
Select the room where the new radiator is to be
placed. The product database is displayed.
Select the desired item. The new radiator is
displayed in the list. When confirmed, it is
placed in the centre of the room.
Change
The function replaces the item of the selected radiator.
Change all
The function replaces all items of all radiators and
assigns an item of the same model series from the
selected manufacturer. DDS-CAD uses the structural
dimensions of the existing radiators as the basis for
Basic functions
the selection.
Delete
The function deletes the selected radiator.
Delete all
The function deletes all radiators from the list and the model.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Lock/lock all
If a radiator is not to be changed by the calculation, you can disable it. Use this
option for example, for simulating existing facilities. The radiator calculation transfers
the output of this radiator to the pipe network calculation.
Zoom
The selected radiator is displayed magnified in the centre of the screen.
Zoom all
The entire drawing is visible on the screen.
Index
150
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
8.4.4 Install and dimension radiator automatically
The radiator calculation by DDS-CAD can accomplish several tasks, depending on its
configuration. Depending on the variety of tasks, carry out one or more calculation
processes, each with the following actions:
Define the scope of the tasks (1). The display is adapted.
Configure the calculation with Options (2)
Click (3). The radiators are selected or modified and applied to the model.
Calculate
(6) (7)(11
(1)
(4)
(10
Basic functions
(12
(13
(8)
(9)
configuration
configuration
(3)
(2)
(5) extensions,
extensions,
The decisive factor here is the configuration of the calculation. Here, you can first
decide whether the radiator is to be dimensioned – and thus changed (4) or whether
only their output for a given spread is to be re-calculated (5). To do this, please read
the following sections.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
If the calculation is to install new radiators, check " Install radiators” (6). DDS-CAD
first checks a room for any windows present and their sizes. Afterwards, radiators
suitable for the selected type (7) are installed below the window according to the
installation parameters (8). Window width and installation height define a frame for
the overall dimensions (see 8.4.4.3, page 152). You can filter the window to be
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
151
Introduction
The limit values Input "Don’t install in rooms with less than” (12) and Input "Max.
radiator output” (13) control the number of radiators in the room. For the explanation,
it is necessary to make a distinction between whether the room already contains
radiators at the time of the calculation process, or whether it is empty:
The calculation is used to optimise the radiators: The effective heating area must be
large enough to provide the required output under the current system
temperatures (1). At the same time, they must not be designed too large for
economical reasons.
Index
152
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Heating and sanitary facilities Erro
r!
During the
(1) (2) (3) (6)
operation, DDS-
For rooms with windows, you can have length and height calculated as a function of
the window dimensions. It is also possible to use fixed settings. To do this, set the
respective flag accordingly. The graphic shows an example: The optimal length (4) is
to be calculated from the window width minus the adjusted value (in this case
120 mm). For the height (5) on the other hand, a fixed value has been set. DDS-CAD
uses the manufacturer's product data for this purpose. For rooms without windows,
Basic functions
the fixed values always apply.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
153
Introduction
You can print out the calculated results in reports. Start the print function in the
Building Information dialogue:
Basic functions
Report Contents
HH_Heater_placement.rpt All radiators are listed individually along with
room number and technical parameters.
HH_Heizkörperliste Fabrikate.rpt The radiators are differentiated by make and
model. Same items are added.
HH_Heaterlist room.rpt The radiators are listed according to their
position in the rooms. Same items are added.
154
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9 Pipes and ventilation ducts
Basic functions
between the visible object in the model and the
corresponding entry in the command list.
24
The starting point (22) defines the medium as a fundamental property of the
25
pipeline and the nature and presentation of the first segment . The pipeline route (23
to 27) in the example only consists of pipe sections and bends. In addition, fittings,
valves and other fixtures are used. You can also define special pipeline sections
where, for example, a different material, a section-based insulation or a different view
configuration
should be used (see 9.7, page 205). The command list uses specific entries to
configuration
describe all fixtures and section breaks. In the endpoint (28) the type of ending with
which the pipe has been terminated is described.
and presentation of the first segment – the initial properties of the pipeline. The
extensions,
22
cf. 3.3.1.2, page 27
23
The direction is indicated by the arrows (see 9.1.3, page 163)
24
The medium applies to the entire pipeline route.
25
Material, size, insulation and presentation may be changed further along the pipeline route.
26
For example, if you start a pipe at a free point, DDS-CAD does not receive any instructions and you have to define all the
parameters yourself. However, if you begin at the connection point of an object (such as the cold water connection of a wash
basin), it will draw information about the medium and the starting height of the line from said object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
155
Introduction
Start (1)
A pipeline can be started by various
operations. A manual setting in this area
is only required when starting at a free
(1) (3) (4) (5)
point (see 9.3.1.1, page 168).
(A (B (C
"Medium"
Default setting: The medium of the branching pipeline (A) is determined by the
main pipeline (C). Any possible change of medium is transferred automatically.
The medium of the branching pipeline can be changed manually. This setting must
be made manually as required (e.g. connection between hot water pipe and
circulation pipe).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
"Insulation"
Default setting: The insulation material of the branching pipeline (A) is determined
by the main pipeline (C). Any possible change is transferred automatically.
The insulation material of the branching pipeline (A) is independent of the main
pipeline and can be defined in the "Insulation” tab (see 9.1.2.3, page 157).
Index
156
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Medium (5)
The medium is the determining fundamental property of the pipeline and cannot be
changed in the course of the pipeline. Changing the medium always affects the entire
pipeline. For a better overview, all available media have been organised into groups.
Basic functions
vates the appropriate item (8). You can also select the items manually. To do
this, click … .
configuration
configuration
Here, you first determine the shape of the
duct cross-section (1). The importance of
the other parameters is based on this
shape. For information on the significance
of the levels, please see 9.1.2.6,
page 160.
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments, extensions,
extensions,
9.1.2.3 Insulation
This tab contains the initial properties of the insulation. You select the material and
the presentation of the insulation, from the starting segment to the end of the pipeline
and/or section change, in accordance with 9.7.2, page 206. Insulation must always
be taken into account when working with DDS-CAD. It has a visual impact and
affects calculations:
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
157
Introduction
Hot water pipes and circulation pipes must be fully insulated! In its calculations,
DDS-CAD checks the temperature of the hot water pipe and the prevailing
ambient temperature in the room. The insulation used determines the resulting
temperature loss and hence affects the size of the circulation pump. It follows: the
better the insulation, the smaller the circulation pump.
In the part list
The insulating materials used are included in the part list.
In the representation
The insulating materials used are displayed in the model according to their
thickness. In this way, you can visualise the whole space required by a pipe.
In the case of ventilation ducts you define the insulation thickness (1) manually and
select the desired material (2) from the product database. In the case of pipes DDS-
CAD automatically searches for the first insulating material with sufficient inner
diameter (4) on the basis of the outer diameter of the pipe (3). With … you can
manually select the insulation material from the product database, and DDS-CAD in
turn automatically checks whether the selected material fits the pipe. Display "Pipe
dimension” (3) is coloured red if the inner diameter of the insulating material is too
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
small.
For the colour representation in the model, first the "No active pen" (5) pen is
suggested. As a result, the insulation adopts the pen of the pipe or of the ventilation
duct. You can effect a colour distinction by selecting a pen.
158
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Type of representation (1)
Basic functions
setting both before drawing a new pipe or
28
for an existing pipe .
Check "Automatically use” (1).
(3) Define the production lengths (2), the
longest (top) and the shortest (bot-
tom).
Select the item (3).
configuration
When drawing the pipe,
configuration
Length DDS-CAD automatically
sets the connections
according to the space
Length available and only uses
the active lengths. The
connecting elements are
extensions,
Note:
If necessary, you can place the connecting elements manually (see 9.5.2.1,
page 200). You define the integration of valves and fittings in the object dialogue
of the respective component (see 9.5.1.2, page 199)
27
e.g. flange, bushing, screw
28
In this second case, refresh the view after configuring the setting. The changed setting will only then become active.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
159
Introduction
boundary conditions that must be met during a calculation-based sizing. Each level is
represented by a specific colour. Optionally, you can display the ventilation network
in the colours of the velocity level or the medium (see 161).
160
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Basic functions
On: The flow direction of the pipes and/or ventilation ducts is
visualised by arrows.
configuration
another through drawing operations (see 9.3.3.1, page 180). This
configuration
results in transfer points, which are set as visible in the storey
being shown and are used to continue the pipeline (see 9.3.1.7,
page 175). The example shows the transition points of various ventilation ducts. You
can see the cross-section and dimension.
levels for sizing by the pressure loss calculation (see 9.1.2.6, page 160). These
levels are visualised by different colours when level representation (left) is enabled. If
level representation is disabled, the ventilation ducts are coloured the same (right).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Level 1 Level 2
Level 4 Level 3
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
161
Introduction
network
9.2.1 General notes
When building a pipe or duct system, you can be flexible and act according to the
overall design status. DDS-CAD offers all possibilities for a practical and step-by-step
approach.
Generally speaking, you will begin with defining the main pipeline and riser points,
coordinate these with colleagues from other professional disciplines and correct as
appropriate. As the design status progresses and information becomes more and
more detailed, you can also advance the network design in stages. In DDS-CAD you
can size the network in each processing stage based on the information available to
you. In this process, you start working with estimated or roughly calculated
requirement values, which you can incorporate into the respective network via
29
substitute objects .
Basic functions
1 2
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
You can use this methodology in further planning, refine the network and also
perform calculations:
29
Substitute objects for ventilation (see 6.2.3, page 90); Substitute objects for potable water and heating facilities (see 8.1.2,
page 123)
Index
162
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
If the positions of the real objects are fixed, remove the substitute objects and
connect the real objects to the pipe network. We recommend using a step-by-step
Step 1
The main lines are
drawn manually
(see 9.3,
page 166).
Step 2
Basic functions
The distribution line
of a medium is pre-
pared manually
(see 9.3,
page 166).
Step 3
The prepared dis-
tribution line of the
first medium is du-
plicated (see 9.4.2,
configuration
page 183).
configuration
Step 4
The objects are
automatically con-
nected (see 9.4.4,
page 188).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
163
Introduction
Using the example started above, we also provide you with two possible approaches
for working in the rooms. The aim is to construct a ventilation system whose main line
has been prepared:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
• branch off from the existing duct and connect at the air terminal.
• start at the air terminal and connect at the duct.
• automatically connect the air terminal at the nearest duct (see 9.4.4.4, page 193).
Index
164
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Working concept II – End ducts with an air outlet
Copying a branch
Buildings with a regular room distribution allow the preparation of a finished branch
Basic functions
with connected air outlets as a template. The sub-section can then be inserted into
the appropriate rooms and subsequently edited (see 9.4.2, page 183).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
165
Introduction
Manually drawing pipes and ventilation ducts is indispensable when designing the
network. You can develop a complete network manually without using auxiliary
30
functions , but you cannot use any auxiliary function without having done manual
preparation beforehand. The procedure (using the example of a pipe) always
corresponds to the order shown. The ventilation ducts behave in a similar way:
to T-piece)
At interconnection point
Define endpoint
(End pipe) from adjacent floor
As connection to
pipeline
Chapter 9.3.2
Page 176
30
e.g. copy sub-networks (9.4.2, page 187) or automatically use connection functions (9.4.4, page 192)
Index
166
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.3.1 Starting point and direction of the first segment
Basic functions
Branch from a vertical page 172
pipe
h
configuration
configuration
Starting at a bend page 173
(convert bend to tee)
extensions,
h
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
167
Introduction
You can define the pipeline's starting point by clicking at any X/Y position.
The start dialogue is displayed and you are given full access to all parameters.
Note
Use this option, for example, to prepare individual pipeline sections and sub-
networks. You can incorporate these later on in your work and complete the
network in stages.
General use
(5) (6)
(4)
Smart start
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
168
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Notes on the starting options
Free
You enter the height of the starting point (A) in figures in
(B the pipeline's starting dialogue. With the default settings
for the drawing direction, the first segment (B) runs
horizontally without incline or slope. You can determine
the course of the first segment (B) by moving the cursor.
(A
On the ceiling
The starting point (A) is set at the room height. With the
(A (B default settings for the drawing direction, the first
segment (B) runs vertically downwards. DDS-CAD
queries the values for the change in height (see 9.3.2.4,
page 178). The starting point is also a transition point to
the storey above. There you can resume the pipe and
Basic functions
continue it (see 9.3.1.7, page 175).
In the floor
The starting point (A) is at the bottom edge of the floor.
With the default settings for the drawing direction, the first
segment (B) runs vertically upwards. DDS-CAD queries
the values for the change in height (see 9.3.2.4,
page 178). The starting point is also a transition point to
the storey below. There you can resume the pipeline and
configuration
(B continue it (see 9.3.1.7, page 175).
configuration
(A
DDS-CAD 7.3
169
Introduction
Application
Horizontal pipeline
Basic functions
Smart start
Vertical pipeline
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
170
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.3.1.3 Branch from horizontal pipeline
(2) (3)
Define position:
On ongoing section
(5)
(1)
Smart start At the start of line section
(4)
Basic functions
Start the pipeline function (1).
Point to the position of the branch. If the position of the cursor is clear, the pa-
rameters of the pipe are displayed in an information box (2). if the position is not
clear, a menu lists the possible connections (3).
Select the desired connection option by clicking . The "General Tee with re-
ducer” dialogue box is displayed (pipes: see 9.5.2.3, page 200; Ventilation ducts:
see Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Error! Bookmark not
configuration
defined.).
configuration
If necessary, adjust the size of the branch and check the item (4).
[PgUp] [PgUp]
ries the height (see 9.3.2.4, page 178).
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
171
Introduction
Application
(1)
(6)
Basic functions
Pipeline
(5)
Note:
To install the tee, the entry which states only medium, size and the Z height is
critical. The displayed height is equal to half the distance between the upper and
lower ends of the vertical (here the end point and bend).
Select the entry for the installation of the tee (here, "PWC Cold-
water” Ø250 Z=1.273). The "New height" dialogue box appears.
Define the installation height as an absolute value (2, in relation to the floor) or a
relative jump (3, to the height of the calculated centre point).
Click OK (4). The "General Tee with reducer” dialogue box is displayed.
If necessary, adjust the size of the branch and check the item (5). If you want to
set the direction of the branch in numbers, enter the angle between the X-axis
and the desired draw direction (6)
Click OK (7). You can draw the pipe.
Index
172
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.3.1.5 Starting at a bend (convert bend to tee)
Application
(1)
Basic functions
Smart start
configuration
configuration
Start the pipeline function.
Point to the bend. It is highlighted.
Click . The "General Tee with reducer” dialogue box is displayed.
extensions,
extensions,
Set the draw direction (1) and click OK . The cursor moves the pipeline in the
specified direction.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
173
Introduction
Application
(1)(2)
Basic functions
Pipeline
(3)
(4)
Point to the object. The object is highlighted. If the position of the cursor at a
specific connection point is definite, the name of the object and medium, size
and height of the connection point are displayed in an information box (1). if the
position is not clear, a menu lists the possible connections (2).
Select the desired connection option by clicking . The product database is dis-
played. The display is limited to the proposed size of the connection point (3)
and only the corresponding materials are shown.
Choose the material. You can draw the pipeline (4).
Index
174
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.3.1.7 Starting at the transition point from an adjacent storey
(1)
Application
Basic functions
(1) (2) (3)
Show connections
from the lower floor/
upper floor
Smart start
configuration
configuration
Enable the "Show connections from below” and/or "Show connections from
above” option. The transition points (1) are visible.
extensions,
extensions,
Start the pipeline function and point to the transition point. The symbol is high-
lighted. An information box shows the starting option (floor or ceiling), starting
height Z and the medium.
Click . The "New Z-height” dialogue box queries the height.
Adjustments,
For the direct transfer to the following storey (2) click UKD/FFB . The riser pipe has
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
175
Introduction
9.3.2.1 Introduction
In other cases, you have to configure the geometry of the fitting or fixture by manual
entries in the object dialogue. This happens, for example:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
For more information on the use of bends, tees and transitions for pipelines see
chapter 9.5, from page 198. The similar functions for ventilation ducts are described
in chapter 9.6, from page 203. For notes on step-by-step insulation and on dashed
line representation, see chapter 9.7, from page 205.
31
The example shows the angles of 15°, 30° and 45°.
Index
176
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
The following sections contain descriptions for the direct drawing operations
(keyboard shortcuts). Specifically, these apply to the following options:
Example: Segment (1) is to lead to the new fixed point (2) in a certain direction by a
certain length via a 90° bend:
(2)
(1)
[]
Basic functions
Press []/[]/[]/[]. The key determines the direction. The "Collect Points”
dialogue is displayed.
Enter the value in metres (m). A helper line indicates the position of the new
fixed point with the current setting.
Click OK . The operation is finished. You can continue your work.
configuration
Example: The position of the fixed point (2) is to be
configuration
(a)
(2) defined at a certain distance (a) to an obstacle (e.g. a
wall). The length of the segment (3) results from the
(3) operation.
extensions,
extensions,
[Shift] + []
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Press [Shift] and move the cursor to the border of the obstacle. DDS-CAD de-
tects the intersection. This is the reference for defining the fixed point (2).
Press the arrow keys to specify the direction for the location of the new fixed
point (here [Shift]. The "Relative from snap point” dialogue box appears.
Enter the distance from the reference point to fixed point in metres (m).
Click OK . The operation is finished. You can continue your work.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
177
Introduction
178
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.3.2.5 Undo last drawing step
Press [backspace] or select the function with the same name in the context
menu. The last fixed point is undone. The function remains active.
While working with a pipeline function, DDS-CAD checks whether the pipeline
collides with other pipelines. The check is performed over all DDS pipeline functions.
You can show the ventilation ducts predefined in electrical engineering, for example,
Basic functions
and develop the pipeline system of the cable ladders without any collisions. The
building's structural elements are also checked in an IFC model with suitable quality.
The check is performed dynamically while you are drawing. If the cursor approaches
an obstacle at the same height, DDS-CAD detects a collision. A menu (1) is
displayed at the cursor, offering three options. Select an option by clicking :
(2)
(1)
configuration
configuration
(4)
(3)
extensions,
extensions,
(5)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
179
Introduction
the current situation. The next click fixes the working height and you can continue
with your work.
Function/Key Note
End function The pipeline is ended at the current fixed point. The pipeline
[ESC] function is ended.
Close and start new The pipeline is ended at the current fixed point. The pipeline
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
[Enter] function remains active and you can define the next starting
point.
End in the storey below A bend is placed at the position of the fixed point. This bend
[Ctrl]+[End] leads the pipeline vertically downwards or upwards. The
pipeline ends as a riser section in the floor/in the ceiling, and
End in the storey above may be continued in the adjacent storey (as per 9.3.1.7,
[Ctrl]+[Home] page 175).
End with cap These functions end the pipeline with the object specified.
The respective dialogue is displayed for configuration. The
End with air outlet
Index
180
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
[A] pipeline function remains active.
End with consumer You can configure a substitute object to simulate a con-
sumer/sub-network.
For ventilation ducts: see 6.2.3, page 87
For pipes (potable water only): see 8.1.2, page 120
Objects have connection points at which the medium is also defined. If the active
pipeline approaches the connection point of an object, DDS-CAD performs a check. If
the media match, the object is highlighted and the connection point's information is
displayed.
32
For example, a connection between a hot and a cold water pipe is prevented by DDS-CAD. On the other hand, it is possible
to connect the circulation to a hot water pipe via a tee.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
181
Introduction
the distribution of the new pipes to the right or to the left of the reference line
• the distances between the pipes
The sizes and materials of the new pipes are taken from the reference line. Of
course, they may need to be changed later. In the following example, several pipes
are to be created parallel to the sub-segment of a cold water pipe and arranged on
both sides of the reference line.
(4)
(6)
(5)
182
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Select the medium of the first parallel pipe (3). Another menu (4) is displayed,
where you can define another parallel.
Basic functions
free point or integrated into an existing duct via a
Repeat branches
tee.
Repeat branch
configuration
configuration
(2)
extensions,
extensions,
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Select the starting point of the sub-section (1). In the example, the tee of the
branch has been chosen.
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Extend selection and copy paste tree”. The entire subsequent sub-
section is automatically selected and the dialogue is displayed.
Select the desired option (2).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
183
Introduction
(1)
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(6)
(5)
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
Select "Insert in existing net same twist”.
Enter the number of copies (2) and the distance (4).
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. DDS-CAD expects the insertion point in
the target pipeline.
Click on the insertion point (3) of the first copy. The first sub-section has been
inserted at the selected position, the others follow at the set distances. If there
are multiple copies the function is ended. If you have only set one copy, the func-
tion remains active. You can define further insertion points.
Index
184
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Rotate 180° and paste
(3)
(1)
Basic functions
(5)
(6)
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
configuration
Select "Insert in existing net opposite twist +180”.
configuration
Enter the number of copies (2) and the distance (4).
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. DDS-CAD expects the insertion point in
the target pipeline.
Click on the insertion point (3) of the first copy. The first sub-section has been
extensions,
inserted at the selected position, the others follow at the set distances. They are
extensions,
rotated 180° relative to the original. If there are multiple copies the function is
ended. If you have only set one copy, the function remains active. You can
define further insertion points.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
185
Introduction
(4)
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
Select "Insert one copy at given height".
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Enter the installation height (3) for the starting point of the new sub-section.
Enter the rotation (4) of the sub-section relative to the original.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. DDS-CAD expect the insertion point.
Click on the insertion point (2). The new sub-section has been inserted at the
selected position with the settings for height and rotation. The function remains
active. You can define another insertion point.
Index
186
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.4.3 Incorporating free sub-sections into the overall network
Option A
Start the pipeline function at the open end of the sub-section (as per 9.3.1.2,
page 170).
Draw the continuation of the pipeline to the main line and make the connection in
accordance with 9.3.3.3, page 181.
Option B
Select the open segment of the pipeline
by clicking . The segment is temporarily
converted into a polyline.
Click on the node at the open end of
the segment. You can move the open end
of the segment with the cursor.
Basic functions
Point to the pipeline where the connection
is to be made. If the pipeline contains the
same medium, it is displayed as a se-
lected object.
Click . The previously open end has
been connected via a tee.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
187
Introduction
An automatic connection function for heating and sanitary objects as well as air
terminals provides assistance while you are building the respective network. It allows
the automatic connection of one or more objects of the same type (such as
washbasins) to the relevant media pipes in one step. Radiator connection pipes can
also be passed directly to the storey below. Any possibly existing connections are
automatically deleted and then renewed. The function assumes that the structure of
the network has been prepared.
188
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
(4)
(1)
(3)
(2)
Basic functions
Executing the connection function
To execute the function, click OK . If the object only has one connection point for a
medium, the connections are executed and the function is ended. Radiators in
particular, but also WCs may contain several connection points for a medium. In this
case DDS-CAD required the position data for the connection. A message about the
medium is displayed and you are prompted to select the connection points:
Adjustments,
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
189
Introduction
Various objects can be connected to pipes in the storey below. The example shows
radiator connections:
Basic functions
Application
Prepare the objects in the upper storey and the distribution pipe in the lower storey.
The operation is executed in the upper storey.
(1)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(2)
Show the storey below (see 5.5, page 80). In addition to the radiators, the distri-
bution pipes in the storey below are visible.
Select the objects to be connected and start the connection function.
Select the desired connection type (1).
Switch to the "Settings“ tab and check "Connect to pipes in the storey below...”
(2).
Click OK . The connections to the selected objects are executed in both sto-
reys. The operation is ended.
Index
190
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.4.4.3 Specific settings for sanitary objects
Input
"Distance to wall” / "Calculate” (1)
The settings control the installation depth for hot and cold
water pipes in the wall and/or the jump by the pipe from the
Basic functions
object to the rear. The status in "Calculate” is crucial.
"Calculate”
configuration
The value in Input "Distance to wall” is ignored. DDS-CAD checks the actual
configuration
distance of the object to the wall and guides the pipe into the wall. The installation
depth is calculated from the pipe diameter. Use this setting if the pipe is to
penetrate into the solid wall.
The pipe jumps from the object to the rear by the distance entered. The actual
distance to the wall is ignored. Use this setting if the object has been mounted on a
front wall, for example.
extensions,
extensions,
"Calculate”
Adjustments,
The slope of the collecting main is read and transferred to the wastewater pipe
from the object up to the connection. The input slope is ignored.
The input slope of the wastewater pipe from the object up to the connection to the
collecting main or to the downpipe applies.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
191
Introduction
When connecting the object to hot and cold water pipes installed in parallel, DDS-
CAD automatically avoids collisions. The connecting line for the distant medium is
guided over or under the closer medium and connected via a bend. The connection
can be made by either a 90° or a 45° connection:
"Bend” (4)
This setting is specifically for floor drains.
2×45° 1×90° It configures the first bend on its way from
the drain to the collecting main.
Basic functions
downpipe.
Input
"Height for bend“ / "Calculate” (6)
This setting is specifically for wastewater lifting units. It defines the height of the
backwater loop. The status in "Calculate” is crucial.
"Calculate”
The input height of the backwater loop is ignored. DDS-CAD calculates this value
depending on the storey height.
The input height of the backwater loop applies.
Index
192
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Both images show the connection to the nearest duct in the current storey. Please
note that air terminals with a lateral connection to the duct must be rotated if the
connection is to work.
Basic functions
the object. The graphic shows three
examples. The symbol (1) has been
highlighted for clarity.
(1)
configuration
configuration
(2)
(1)
(1)
extensions,
extensions,
Left: View from below from the room to the air terminal in the suspended ceiling (1)
Right: View in the intermediate space between the suspended ceiling and concrete
floor with the connection to the top.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
193
Introduction
following example, several air terminals have been placed and the main line of the
ventilation system has been drawn. None of the objects are connected at the
beginning of the operation.
(4)
(2)
(1)
(3)
Depending on the connection option chosen, settings on how the bends (3) are used
may be required. The settings (4) are used to define specific parameters (see
page 197).
Index
194
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Executing the connection function
Basic functions
Message in the information list Cause and possible remedy
"It is not possible to connect to the duct The main duct is too short, the air outlet is
(the connection may be outside the outside the duct end. Move the air outlet or
duct). Operation cancelled." extend the duct.
"The connection is only possible if the You have selected multiple objects and one
connection point allows lateral or more objects can only be connected from
connection, not above/below. Operation above/below. Connect the objects in their
cancelled." own group or individually.
"The connection is only possible if the You have selected multiple objects and one
object has connection points on the top. or more objects can only be connected from
configuration
Operation cancelled." the side. Connect the objects in their own
configuration
group or individually.
"It is not possible to connect at the There is not enough space between the air
current angle (not enough distance outlet and the duct. Select a larger angle or
between duct and object). Operation move the air outlet.
cancelled."
"Only 90° bends are possible in You have chosen an incorrect angle. Use a
extensions,
rectangular ducts. Operation cancelled." 90° bend to connect the outlet to the
extensions,
rectangular duct.
"The distance between the air outlet and The distance from air outlet to duct is too
duct is too small for the selected small for the set parameters. Select a
connection. Operation cancelled." different connection type, angle, distance, or
move the air outlet.
Adjustments,
"Some objects of the connection are The connection is made, but some objects
Adjustments,
overlapping (e.g. bends). Is this are overlapping (e.g. bends). Check the
intentional?" connection in 3D.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
195
Introduction
Each row in the information list represents one air terminal. Using the information list,
you are taken directly to the respective air terminal:
Select an entry. The air outlet is displayed as a selected object.
Click Zoom object . The associated air outlet is displayed magnified in the centre of
the screen. You can check the local conditions.
196
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
(3/4/5)
The settings define the distance from the main duct to the first bend for the following
connection options:
Basic functions
From above
(vertical)
configuration
(horizontal)
The connections of the selected air terminals lead to the ceiling (cf. page 193)
The selected air terminals are connected to the nearest duct on the current storey.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
197
Introduction
All pipeline objects have options that configure their rotation and/or orientation on the
pipe centre line. Essentially we have to distinguish between two groups:
The rotation of bends and tees always affects the flow direction of the connected pipe
33
segment, which is why this parameter is set when drawing the pipe . In pipes that
flow purely horizontally and vertically, this is done automatically by a drawing
operation. You only have to enter the rotation manually as an angle when there is an
inclined jump in height or an inclined branch, or when flowing from a horizontal line.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
For both groups, there is also a distinction as to whether they are in a horizontal
(lying down) or a vertical (standing) pipeline.
33
A subsequent change is possible in terms of the program, but should only be performed with extreme caution. In any case,
connected pipes are separated by rotated connecting pieces. The connection to the following network must be renewed
manually.
Index
198
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Rotation in horizontal pipes
Top=270°
Fittings Bends and T-parts
Left=180° Right=0°
Direction of Bottom=90°
t l
90°
Y
Basic functions
Fittings Bends and T-parts
180° 0°
(1)
270° X
configuration
configuration
You can define the type of incorporation
into the pipe network for all pipeline
objects. Under the "Flange” tab you can
select the connecting element as an item
(1). In order to actually use it, check
"Add flange to object” (2). In this way the
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
199
Introduction
9.5.2.2 Bend
Bends are always installed in the pipe when drawing and configured automatically in
most cases. Each fixed point that is followed by a new segment after a direction
change is converted into a bend (see 9.3.2.1, page 176). The technical parameters
(material and size) are taken from the pipe used. The geometric parameters (angle
and direction) are determined by the drawing operation.
A manual configuration
may be required in special
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
9.5.2.3 Tee
Index
200
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Tees are installed in the pipe network through the following options:
see 9.5.1.1
configuration
Reducers are installed in the pipe network through the following
options:
• Automatically, through the pipe network calculation
• Manually, when drawing the line (see 9.3.2.1, page 176)
•
extensions,
Manually, by subsequent insertion (see 9.5.3, page 201)
extensions,
Reducer
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
201
Introduction
(1)
Procedure:
Select the required function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line
shows the "Locate flow segment and press left mouse button” prompt.
Basic functions
202
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Basic functions
(2)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
203
Introduction
Attenuator
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
Procedure:
Select the desired function. The cursor turns into a crosshair and moves the
symbol of the built-in device. The message line shows the following prompt: "Lo-
cate flow segment and press left mouse button”.
Click in the duct. The object dialogue of the built-in part is displayed.
Select the desired item (1) and correct other settings (2) where necessary.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click OK . The built-in device is located in the duct. The function remains ac-
tive. You can insert the same device at other locations by clicking .
Warning!
Components that depend on flow, such as flow rate regulators, are inserted in the
drawing direction of the duct.
Index
204
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
(1)
Basic functions
(2)
(3)
(4)
Split pipe
configuration
configuration
Select the "Split a pipe” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message
line shows the following prompt: "Locate flow segment and press left mouse but-
ton”.
Click on the position where the division is to be made (2). The "Start drawing
extensions,
is ended.
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
205
Introduction
Both functions operate according to the same principle. You create an entry in the
command list, which defines the status of this position until the next change. The
graphic shows an example:
Insulation
The pipe was been
drawn from left to right.
Command (35) enables
the insulation.
Command (41) disables
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
it.
Linetype:
A ventilation duct is to
be marked as partially
obscured. Command
(45) starts the labelling.
Command (47) ends it.
Index
206
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
The use of both functions is described using the example of insulation:
Basic functions
insulation.
configuration
Insulation
configuration
extensions,
extensions,
Select "Insert insulation” function in the toolbox. The cursor turns into a cross-
hair. The message line shows the following prompt: "Locate flow segment and
press left mouse button”.
Click on the position in the pipe, from which the insulation is to be enabled or
disabled. The "Insulation” dialogue box is displayed.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Configure the insulation and click OK . The selected setting applies from the
selected position in the drawing direction of the pipe. The function remains active
and can be used further along the pipe.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
207
Introduction
208
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
9.8.2 Changing the pipeline route
Basic functions
Example 1 – Moving a tee:
Before After
configuration
Example 2 – Moving a bend:
configuration
Before After
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
209
Introduction
A segment is the
connection between two
pipeline objects, e.g. from
the starting point to next
bend (left) or between two
bends (right). To enable a
segment for editing, select
it by clicking .
Node
Editing with polyline: move The node (in this case the starting point of the line)
can only be moved in the flow direction of the
segment. The segment is thus extended or
shortened. If necessary, the direction of the next
Basic functions
When approaching another pipeline with the same medium, the connection can be made
via a tee (see 9.4.3, page 187).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Segment
Editing with polyline: parallel shift The segment is shifted in parallel. The
function starts when you click the
symbol
Move pipe insert The segment is split and you can change
the route (see below).
Index
210
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
The function "Displace parallel polyline-like” is best described using an example. It is
Before After
Select the segment by clicking . The centre point is marked by an open square.
Basic functions
Click on the symbol . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Displace parallel polyline-like”. The cursor moves the two movable ends
of the new sub-segments.
The colour of the movable sub-segments can be black or red. This symbolises the
status of the bends, if a fixed point is defined at the current cursor position.
Colour Meaning
Black The angle of the first bend is equivalent to a commercially available standard
size (15°, 30°, 45° or 60°).
configuration
Red The angle of at least one bend differs from the commercially standard sizes.
configuration
Defining the new pipeline route
Define the new pipeline route. Set the positions of each of the new bends by clicking
: Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
211
Introduction
press [ESC]. The pipeline will be displayed with the new route.
[ESC]
The operation is useful for example, to straighten the pipeline route. You can remove
bends without having to break up the pipeline and subsequently repair it.
Before After
Basic functions
However, it is critical that you first define the pipeline segment to be edited and
convert it into a polyline. You can then edit it. At the end of the operation, you need to
resolve the polyline back into individual segments. This procedure is also best
described using an example.
(1)
Before: Individual
objects of the selected
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(2)
(3)
212
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Pipes and ventilation ducts Erro
r!
Defining the new pipeline route
Nodes and segments of the newly formed object can be edited using the polyline
(4)
To edit the example described above, use the "Delete node” function (4). In this way,
you get a visually continuous route (5). However, the remaining segment is still a
Basic functions
polyline. This polyline has to be converted back into a pipeline.
(5)
DDS-CAD 7.3
213
Introduction
Select the two bends. You cannot select any other objects.
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Replace with one bend”. The bends have been replaced. The operation
is ended.
Index
214
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10 Network calculations
Consumers
Label calculation points
Pipes
Chapter 10.2
Page 215
Fittings
Basic functions
Pipe network calculation Pipe network calculation Pressure loss calculation in the
Heating pipe network Potable water network ventilation system
configuration
configuration
Work with the pipe
Calculated results Chapter 10.5
network table
Page 232
Calculated results
Chapter 10.3.5.2
extensions,
Page 225
extensions,
Chapter 10.3
Page 218
To prepare for a pipe network calculation, you have to assign the pipe network name
and define the starting position for the network analysis. To do this, set one or more
calculation points (depending on the type of network). The line segment in which a
calculation point is located, is declared as the main line. All lines branching off are
therefore sub-sections.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
215
Introduction
before after
34
It is not possible to calculate the entire system in one step.
Index
216
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
If the network structure is appropriate, you can consider both the cold water line and
35
the hot water line separately and assign different pipe network names. However, it
(3)
(1)
(4)
(2)
Basic functions
Set
calculation point
Select the "Set a calculation point” function. The message line shows the
"Locate flow segment and press left mouse button” prompt.
Click on the first or last segment of a pipeline (1) or the branch of a new sub-
section (2). The "Properties of Calculation Point” dialogue box is displayed.
configuration
Assign the pipe network name (3) and click OK . The calculation starting point
configuration
is symbolised by a rectangle with rounded corners (4). The function remains ac-
tive. Depending on the type of network, you may have to define the calculation
starting point of the missing media (see below).
35
It may be that only one medium or the other is present in the system.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
217
Introduction
network
10.3.1 Introduction
When calculating the heating pipe network, DDS-CAD first determines the volume
flow required by the consumers. Then the system dimensions the sizes of the pipes
such that a maximum heating medium flow velocity and/or a certain pressure loss
cannot be exceeded at any point. The pipe dimensions are adjusted in the model
where required. A hydraulic balancing also takes place, in which the preferences for
radiator valves and lock shield valves are calculated. DDS-CAD thus ensures that for
the designed system there is:
• uniform heat dissipation/heating times in all rooms
• good regulation behaviour by the thermostatic valves
• optimal return temperatures
• optimised energy consumption (heating, pump's electrical consumption)
The expansion vessel used is checked and compared with the parameters of the
calculated system. If DDS-CAD notices a difference, an appropriate size is
suggested.
Basic functions
Warning!
For a correct calculation, all fixtures necessary for operation (pumps and valves)
and safety devices must be inserted in the network. However, the heat generator
(if it is not known) can be skipped.
Building
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
218
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10.3.2 Configuring the calculation
The system parameters include system temperatures (1) and the medium used in the
system (5).
Basic functions
The boundary conditions stipulate the limit values of variable parameters and how
DDS-CAD is to react if values deviate from these limits. The network can be
dimensioned such that a maximum flow rate and/or a maximum pressure drop is not
exceeded at any point in the network (1). You also select a minimum size (3), which
(regardless of these limits) must not be exceeded. If valve authority and/or pressure
loss of the radiator valves exceed the specifications, DDS-CAD can shift the excess
pressure loss to the lock shield valves (7).
The radiator outputs required when dimensioning can either be read from a
calculated radiator design (see 8.4.4, page 151) or be read as a fixed specification
configuration
from the product database (8). Choose the second option for example, if you are
configuration
working with pre-specified radiators in an existing network.
You may have different pipe materials in the pipe network as a result of extensive
changes. If you want to ensure a uniform material is used, check "Same material in
entire pipe network” (9). DDS-CAD uses the first sub-section as a basis and transfers
its pipe material to all other sub-sections. In this way, the size adjustment is not
extensions,
affected. If the materials of the sub-sections are to remain unchanged, uncheck the
extensions,
During the calculation, you can also change the make of the radiator valves and lock
shield valves (6). To do this, check "Replace all radiator valves and lock shield
valves”. Then determine the manufacturer and the item.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
219
Introduction
Switch to the "Calculate” tab. DDS-CAD analyses the pipe network. If there are no
errors in the pipe network (case A), you are taken to the pipe network table. The
dialogue box displays the number of radiators and/or underfloor heating distributors
within the building and reports the number of correctly and incorrectly connected
objects (1).
A
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
However, if the system determines that there are incorrectly connected radiators in
the network, it displays an information list (case B). In this case:
220
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10.3.4 Working with the pipe network table
The pipe network table lists all sub-sections of the active main line with its settings
and calculation results.
(2)
(3)
(4)
Basic functions
The filter (1) is used to enable the display of the main line. Clicking on a sub-
section opens a context menu with additional functions:
"Lock” fixes the size of the sub-section, so that it cannot be changed by the
calculation.
Warning!
Locking a sub-section in the feed has no effect on the parallel sub-section in the
configuration
return (and vice versa).
configuration
"Lock all” fixes the sizes of the entire network. In this way you can simulate an
existing pipe network, for example. DDS-CAD only calculates the volume flows and
pressure losses under the current conditions and outputs them in the logs. extensions,
"Zoom" magnifies the selected sub-section in the centre of the screen. Use "Zoom
extensions,
select the sub-section in the model by clicking . This will take you back to the pipe
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
221
Introduction
Freeze pipe The size of the sub-section may be changed by the calculation.
dimension
The size of the sub-section is locked against changes.
Basic functions
222
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
Basic functions
(1)
Application configuration
configuration
Click Calculate (1). The "Select pump” dialogue box is displayed.
extensions,
extensions,
Set the pump pressure and click OK . The "Safety valve response pressure”
dialogue box is displayed.
Enter the response pressure and click OK . An information list provides vari-
ous notes. If the expansion vessel used is too large, a smaller one is suggested.
If it is too small, it is automatically replaced by a larger one.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Confirm the information list with OK . The "Heating pipe network calculation" is
displayed with the calculated results.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
223
Introduction
The pipe
network table (1)
shows the
calculated
results of each
individual sub-
section, as well
as pressure
loss, pump
pressure and
volume flow of
the entire
network (2).
Clicking OK
(1) (2) (3) (3) takes you
Basic functions
back to the
Building
Information
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(4)
(5) (6)
dialogue.
Index
224
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
Report Contents
HPS_Rohrnetzberechnung einzelner List of the sub-sections of the selected line
Strang.rpt according to the pipe network calculation.
HPS_Ventilauslegung einzelner Strang.rpt Valve default settings for all radiators in
the line, separated by room.
Pressing System (5) gives you a view of the most important system parameters. OK
(6) transfers the calculated result into the drawn pipe network. DDS-CAD opens all
storeys and change the sizes.
10.3.5.2 ((Valves))
Basic functions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
225
Introduction
work
10.4.1 Introduction
By calculating the potable water pipe network in accordance with DIN 1988, the sizes
of the supply and circulation pipes are defined and transferred to the drawn network.
DDS-CAD uses a different approach for this process. All consumption points and
individual resistances are included. Cold water and hot water networks can be
considered both separately and together. For example, the calculation of the hot
water network does not require that a cold water network exists. The same goes for
the opposite case.
Warning!
The hot water and circulation pipes must be insulated in order to ensure a correct
calculation (see 9.7, page 205).
Basic functions
Building
water lines.
Select the network that you
want to calculate (1) and
click
Calculate (2). The "Potable wa-
(2)
ter pipe network calculation”
is displayed with the "Op-
tions” tab active.
Configure the calculation.
Index
226
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10.4.2 Configuring the calculation
Basic functions
added to the peak flow (VS).
Only each The peak flow (VS) is calculated depending on the selected use (see
greatest of all 5.4.1.1, page 72):
similar tap Business, hospital, school
points The volume flows (VR) of all consumption points in the network are
added to the peak flow (VS).
Residential building, hotel
Objects of the same type in the room are compared. The room's
largest consumption point is considered for the peak flow (VS).
Only the Objects of the same type in the room are compared. The room's
largest in the largest consumption point is considered for the peak flow (VS).
configuration
room
configuration
Only the Objects of the same type in the region are compared. The region's
largest in the largest consumption point is considered for the peak flow (VS).
region
Note:
extensions,
You can modify how each separate consumption point is considered in the
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
227
Introduction
menu.
228
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10.4.3.2 Information in the pipe network table
Basic functions
VR, l/s Total flow rate
VS, l/s Peak flow rate
Invalid path blank
configuration
on .
configuration
Pipes, mbar Pressure loss of the pipes
Fittings, mbar Pressure loss through fittings
Valves, mbar Pressure loss through valves
Filters, mbar Pressure loss through filters
Meters, mbar Pressure loss through meters
extensions,
mbar
Geodetic, mbar Pressure loss through geodetic head
Sanitary Pressure loss through sanitary objects
objects, mbar
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
229
Introduction
If you have configured the calculation, you can dimension the pipe network:
(1)
Basic functions
Application
Click Calculate (1). The calculation routine starts. For large networks, an information
window is displayed, showing the processing status. In the case of an existing
circulation line, the "Auswahl der Pumpe" (Select pump) dialogue box is dis-
played. If there is no current circulation line, the calculation is performed without
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
any prompt.
Set the pump pressure and click OK . The main dialogue of the pipe network
calculation is displayed with the calculated results.
Index
230
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
10.4.4 Calculated results
Basic functions
(1)
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
(2)
Print (2) starts the printout of
the calculated results for the
selected line. Select the desired
report.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Report Contents
HTS_Drinking water.rpt List of the sub-sections after the pipe network calculation
with the pressure losses and the parameters of the sanitary
objects.
HTS_Circulation.rpt You get a list of all sub-sections of the circulation and hot
water pipe with the pressure losses, heat losses and the
parameters of the sanitary objects (calculated by
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
231
Introduction
Building
232
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
Select a sub-section and click on a row in the table (1). The components of
the selected sub-section are displayed along with their data (dimension, velocity,
zeta coefficient and pressure loss) in the table on the right (2).
Click on a component in the right-hand table (2).
This opens a context menu with the following contents:
configuration
configuration
Message in the context menu Function
"Zoom all" The drawing is displayed in full on the screen.
"Zoom selected object to the right" The selected component is magnified and
displayed in the top right of the screen.
"Zoom selected object in full" The selected component is magnified and
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
233
Introduction
The "Config” tab (1) shows the actual state of the duct network, as it is represented in
Basic functions
the model. You can print out the current values in reports.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(2)
234
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Network calculations Erro
r!
Report Contents
In the "Calculate” tab you can size the pipes and ducts and balance the system.
Pressing UPDATE transfers the calculated results to the "Config” tab.
(1)
Basic functions
(1)
configuration
configuration
"Calculate adding transitions“ mode:
When sizing the ducts and pipes, further reducers are automatically inserted by the
program. The sizing and thus further reducers are affected by the values specified in
the settings. Only the width of rectangular ducts is changed during sizing, not their
height. Tubular ducts are re-sized along their central axis.
extensions,
extensions,
The dimensions of the ducts and pipes are not changed. The air outlets and dampers
are adjusted according to their set values. After sizing the duct and pipe network, you
can apply the changes to the DDS drawing.
This tab provides you with a better overview of the network structure.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
235
Introduction
(1)
(2)
The "Config" tab defines the boundary conditions and parameters for the pressure
loss calculation and duct network calculation.
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
236
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11 Distribution boards and switchboards
Basic functions
• activate existing distribution
boards
• call the building's symbol in the
installation plan or distribution
schematic diagram
The database
is where you manage the content
of the distribution board, its circuits
and equipment. You can:
configuration
configuration
• build the distribution structure
• establish the energy balance
• size the lines
• connect and label components
in the installation plan
• compile documentation on the
extensions,
distribution boards
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
237
Introduction
b d
Object
Housing
Equipment
Database
Feed
Final circuit 1
Final circuit 2
Sheet management
Index
238
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11.2 The distribution board as an object
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Basic functions
Creating a distribution board
Click New (2). In "Define board” a new distribution board number is
displayed.
In Input "Reference" (3) enter the short description for the distribution. This ap-
pears in the circuit label of the connected components and as a distribution
board label in the installation plan.
In Input "Description” (4) enter the function of the distribution. This appears in
the title fields of the distribution board documentation and can be enabled as
configuration
symbol text in the installation plan.
configuration
Enabling a distribution board
Enable a distribution board (1) if the project already contains several distribution
boards and you want to edit, draw or label a specific one.
You can position the distribution board housing in the installation plan and for the
representation of the cabinet structure.
Select an item (7).
Enter the install height in Input
"Bottom" (5) or Input
"Top" (6). The other value
Adjustments,
is recalculated.
Adjustments,
Click Place symbol (8). The symbol is displayed at the cursor as a dynamic sym-
bol.
Fix the symbol in the model. The function is ended.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
239
Introduction
cuit table
11.3.1 Content and functions
The "Circuit List” tab is used to manage the contents of the distribution board. The
function managed all circuits of the active distribution system and calculates the
power requirements of the operating currents of the final circuits and checks the
dimensions of the equipment. Equipment that is too small is highlighted (in red).
A calculation compares the equipment to the current load conditions.
The picture shows a high-voltage current sub-distribution system with one feed (1),
one series fuse and/or RCD for each of several circuits (2) and some final circuits (3):
(1)
Basic functions
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
New (4) starts the function to create a new circuit (see 11.3.3, page 245).
Draw circuit (5) is only enabled when the installation drawing is open and calls the line
of the selected circuit for drawing. In this way you can label and electrically connect
the components in the drawing (see 13.5, page 332).
Circuit tools (6) can make extensive changes throughout the entire distribution board
database. This may include the reorganisation of the numbers and names of circuits,
components, cables and terminals. Any subsequent changes to the structure of the
distribution board always shifts, deletes and re-inserts these elements. In this case, if
the numbering ends up out of order it can be reorganised by pressing Circuit tools .
(see 11.5; page 266).
Index
240
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Each cell in the circuit table is used for a specific purpose to configure a circuit and/or
Basic functions
subsequent ones to the main busbar.
configuration
via the main busbar (final circuit 3, 5, 6
configuration
and 7) or if the voltage is drawn from
the preceding circuit (final circuit 4 and
8). The two settings are exchanged by
double clicking on cell "2/3" for one
row.
extensions,
extensions,
In addition, the colour of the horizontal bar shows whether a line has already been
drawn for this circuit in the working model of the installation plan. In the example this
applies to the final circuits 3 and 4. There is not yet a line for the final circuits 5 to 8.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
241
Introduction
Button [Aux Contacts] opens the product database and allows the selection of
auxiliary contacts which are allocated to the equipment. The example shows a three-
pole contactor, to which an additional auxiliary contact block has been assigned.
Index
242
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Cell "cable" (e)
Basic functions
"Load Data and Calculation”
contains the connection values of the
supplied system. If you change a
parameter (e.g. efficiency), DDS-CAD
instantly adjusts all of the dependent
parameters (in this case the delivered
power Pab). The operating current is
transferred to the circuit parameters for
calculating the power balance and is
also used to calculate the permissible
configuration
cable length. Press Calculate to start the
configuration
cable calculation according to the
installation conditions.
DDS-CAD 7.3
243
Introduction
The display of the circuit table is variable and can be customised. For example, you
can make the display layout easier to read and hide unnecessary columns. You can
also specify which data should be displayed in the cells.
Example:
To monitor the power
balance, the settings of
the coincidence factor
and the value of the
operating current are
needed in the "circuit"
cell.
(1)
(2)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3)
Select "Circuits” (1). The parameters of the selected cell (2) can be enabled for
display or disabled.
Set the display for the selected cell.
Disable the display of unneeded columns (3)
Click OK . The circuit table only displays the desired content:
Index
244
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11.3.3 Working with the circuit table
By creating a
new circuit,
(3)
you insert a
new row in
the circuit
(4) table. The
order in the
database also
determines
(5) the order in
the
distribution
(6) diagram.
(1) (2)
(7) (8)
Basic functions
Click New (1). The "New Circuit” dialogue box is displayed. All circuit layouts
are arranged in different tables. By checking "Show user defined Circuits” (2)
36
you switch between the standard tables and your own circuit layouts .
Select a table (3). The content of the bottom list (4) changes.
Select a circuit layout (4).
Correct operating current (7), the coincidence factor (6) and the other parameters (5) 37.
configuration
configuration
Einfügen inserts the new
36
For more information on editing and creating new circuit layouts, please refer to chapter 1 on page 603.
37
Notes on selecting the circuit layout and the effect of the parameters of operating current (Ib1), operating current (Ib2), use
category and coincidence can be found in the online help or in 11.4, page 262.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
245
Introduction
Function/shortcut Meaning
Cut out The component is copied to the clipboard and removed from the
Basic functions
Cut out row The selected circuits are copied to the clipboard and removed from
[Ctrl]+[X] the table. You can paste them at another position.
Copy row The selected circuits are copied to the clipboard. You can paste
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
246
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11.3.4 Reorganising a distribution board
By using the"Ändern" (Edit) function (1) you can adjust the names of the circuits and
equipment to a selected pattern or naming schema in stages. You can also modify
the technical parameters and re-size the equipment.
(a) (b) (c)
Example:
The example shows a
distribution board whose circuit
IDs (a), component names (b)
and cable IDs (c) are
disordered. They should follow
a uniform schema. To do this,
use Change (1).
Basic functions
(1)
Change calls a dialogue box, which provides different options for modifying each object
class (circuit, comp. group, cables or terminal list). By selecting the object class (2)
configuration
DDS-CAD shows the options available for modifying it (3). Area (4) is where you
configuration
define the scope of the operation.
(4)
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
247
Introduction
(1)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The new circuit IDs can now be used as a template and numbering schema for the
other object classes.
Index
248
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Step 2 – Change the component names
Basic functions
Click Method (4). The "Numbering method" dia-
logue box is displayed.
Select "Same as circuit number" (5) and
click OK . The dialogue box is closed, the
(5) numbering schema is selected. You return to
the "Edit” dialogue box.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. The
name of the selected component groups has
been adapted to the respective circuit ID (6).
configuration
configuration
extensions,
(6)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
249
Introduction
(3)
Note:
In this case it is not necessary to re-configure the setting for the method. The
setting selected in the previous step remains active.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
250
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11.3.4.2 Defining the scope
(1)
Full table
The function searches the entire table for the objects to be modified. Manually
defined objects are not changed.
Basic functions
From ... to ... in the table
The function searches a defined range of the table for the objects to be modified.
Manually defined objects are not changed.
configuration
configuration
Full table and manual components
The change is applied to all object groups. This setting is only useful if the "Comp.
group” option has been selected.
"From" ... "To"). This setting is only useful if the "Comp. group” option has been
extensions,
selected.
DDS-CAD 7.3
251
Introduction
Circuits
Changes to the "Circuits" object class affect the
text and parameters of the circuits.
number". Input
1
Circuit numbers with sub-number on level two (1)
Circuits at level two are numbered by a decimal point.
1.1 1.2 1. 1.4 1.5
252
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Object group
(1) (3)
(2) (4)
(5)
Basic functions
Add block separator/Remove block separator (3)
Displaying the block separators is switched on or off for the components within the
scope.
configuration
configuration
Edit name (1)
The names of the components (F-fuses, S-switches...) are changed. You can filter
the objects to be changed according to their naming schema. Enter the schema in
Input "Old value”. If Input "Old value" remains blank, all components are changed.
An additional name of max. 8 characters can be defined for the components within
extensions,
the scope and be displayed in the circuit diagrams. You can filter the objects to be
changed according to their naming schema. Enter the schema in Input "Old value”. If
Input "Old value” remains blank, all components are changed.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
253
Introduction
(1)
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
The cables in the scope are given a new cable dimension. You can filter the cable
dimensions to be changed. Enter the cable dimension to be changed in Input "Old
value”. If Input "Old value” remains blank, all cable dimensions are changed.
254
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Terminal block
(3) (1)
(2)
Basic functions
New terminal ID (2)
The terminals of the terminal block (3) are re-numbered. Specify the naming schema
( Method ) and Input "Start number”.
configuration
configuration
By building the distribution board structure, you create the basis for the energy
balance, the distribution system diagrams and the circuit labelling for the switching
and terminal equipment in the installation plan. To do this, define the circuits, taking
into account the connection values and the coincidence factor. When doing so,
proceed in a structured manner as follow: extensions,
First develop the sub-board and then the main distribution board.
extensions,
The sub-board must be created first, before a supply line to the sub-board can be
defined in the main distribution board. In a subsequent step, transfer the energy
balance of the supplied sub-board into the main distribution board.
The feed adds the connection values of the systems, taking into account the
Adjustments,
coincidence factors. Transferring the energy balance to the main distribution board is
only possible if a feed has been defined in the sub-board.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
255
Introduction
The actual load is only created with the addition of final circuits. Here, the operating
currents of the final circuits are multiplied by the coincidence factor and added to the
feed.
Any change to the load conditions within the distribution board is immediately
recorded and displayed. The "circuit" cell always displays the value of the phase
conductor under the highest load. In the following example, single pole final circuits
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
have been added. DDS-CAD assigns the circuits to a phase conductor in consecutive
order (L1, L2, L3). Therefore, the higher nominal current is only displayed in the feed
when a fourth circuit is added.
Index
256
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
11.4.1.2 Configuring final circuits
Basic functions
(3)
(4)
To calculate the power balance of the whole distribution board, the operating current
Ib1 (1) is reduced by the coincidence factor and added to the feed of the distribution
board. Starting currents that are expected in motor circuits are included in this
calculation.
configuration
Example 1 – Lighting circuit (resistive load)
configuration
Entered values and settings
Circuit layout "ZMF3A – Light with protective device"
Operating current (Ib1) 24 A
Coincidence 50%
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
257
Introduction
Warning!
Basic functions
The dimensions of the components and cables are filtered according to the
operating current in the product database. Should the product database provided
incorrectly sized components, you have neglected to make corrections in Input
"Main load (lb1)”. You can cancel the function and re-start or continue and change
the necessary parameters later on.
Several changes may be required while configuring the sub-board. New circuits may
be added gradually, existing ones moved and surplus ones deleted. In addition, load
parameters of the final circuits are changed. During this process, the following effects
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
are expected:
• unsymmetrical load distribution
• exceeding the rated currents of one or more devices
Exceeding the rated currents can therefore be a direct consequence of an
unsymmetrical load distribution. Cases of the rated current being exceeded are
indicated visually. The name of the equipment is displayed in bold red font. However,
adjustment is not automatic but must be triggered by starting a calculation function.
To do this, you have the following options:
• Produce a symmetrical load in the distribution board
• Balance the dimensions of individual circuits
• Balance the dimensions of the entire distribution board
Index
258
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Procedure for producing a symmetrical load in the distribution board
(1)
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
(3)
Choose the settings "Circuits” (1) and "Phase Distribution" (2) for the "All in
Circuit List" (3), and click OK . The "Edit” dialogue box is closed. All modified
configuration
configuration
cells are displayed in bold green font and the load on the feed has been cor-
extensions,
rected.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
259
Introduction
Open the distribution board and click on the circuit to be balanced. The
context menu is displayed:
Basic functions
Select "Update Components Dimension”. The devices on the circuit have been
adjusted to the load conditions. The names of the changed equipment are dis-
played in bold green text.
(1)
Index
260
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Click Circuit tools (1) The "Edit” dialogue box is displayed:
(2)
(3)
Choose the settings "Circuits” (1) and "Re-calculate" (2) for the "All in Circuit
List" (3), and click OK . The "Edit” dialogue box is closed. All equipment has
been balanced to the current load conditions. The names of the changed equip-
ment are displayed in bold green text.
Basic functions
11.4.1.4 Energy balance in the main distribution boards
If the sub-boards are configured, you can defined a "Zuleitung zur Unterverteilung …"
(Supply line to sub-distribution...) in the main distribution board. While opening the
function, DDS-CAD queries which sub-board is to be supplied. You then call the
energy balance of this sub-board and transfer it to the main distribution system.
Procedure: "Supply line to the sub-board" from the main distribution board
configuration
configuration
To supply the sub-board, you also need to define a new circuit. Select "VSF –
Supply to Sub-Switchboard" or "VSP – Supply to Sub-Switchboard with kWh me-
ter" (1):
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
261
Introduction
Select the sub-board to be supplied and click OK to stop the process. The
"Supply line to sub-distribution” circuit is part of the main distribution board. You
can call the energy balance of the sub-board and transfer it to the main distribu-
tion board.
Open the circuit parameters of the supply line by double clicking on the circuit
cell (1).
(1)
Basic functions
This "Supply" dialogue box is displayed, the load conditions (2) are not up to
date:
(2)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3)
Click Calculate . DDS-CAD transfers the operating currents of the sub-board to the
main distribution board. You can continue the work.
Warning!
Repeat the update each time the load is shifted in the sub-board.
262
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Basic functions
Supply from main distributor L1 L2
L3 Display
Synchronism: 70% 33.18 A 25.34 A 17.5 A 33.18 A
External conductor:
L1 11.2 A
Operating current:
16 A
Final circuit 2
External conductor:
configuration
L1 11.2 A
configuration
Operating current:
16 A
Final circuit 3
External conductor:
L1 11.2 A
Operating current:
16 A
extensions,
extensions,
Final circuit 4
External conductor:
L1 25.0 A
Operating current:
25 A
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
263
Introduction
By configuring the distribution system, DDS-CAD first sizes the cable dimensions
according to the load. The reduction in load rating due to unfavourable installation
conditions as per DIN VDE 0100 Supp. 5 is not included in this calculation.
You can also perform this correction via the circuit table. Alternatively you can call the
line to be calculated by double clicking from the installation drawing. We describe
using the function via the circuit table:
Warning!
The function described only considers the loop impedance of the current line to
the current distribution board when calculating the short-circuit ampere. The
upstream network via the supply line from the main distribution board and to the
transformer is not included. This calculation is therefore only suitable for sizing
final circuits .
Open the distribution board and click on the circuit to be balanced. The
context menu is displayed:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select "CDC Calculation”. The "IEC 60364 based calculation” dialogue box is
displayed.
Index
264
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
The dialogue box is divided into two levels. Under the "Calculation" tab you can
Basic functions
Under the "Cable installation input” tab you can define the cable length to be
calculated, the accumulation and the prevailing environmental conditions. This is
where you define the worst case in the line:
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
To execute the calculation, click Calculate dimension . To apply the amended cable
dimension in the circuit table and in the drawing, click OK . To abort and close the
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
265
Introduction
To create a data distribution board, follow the procedures described in chapter 11.2,
page 239. Make sure to select the correct distribution board housing. The product
database contains various types of data and network cabinets:
Basic functions
Configuring a data distribution board with patch panels is realised by using the "New
Circuit” function (see 11.3.3.1, page 245). The main selection (1) contains the
different categories. In the selection (2) choose the required patch panel. The circuit
parameters (3) are irrelevant and have no function.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
(2)
(3)
After starting with Add or Insert DDS-CAD first asks for the desired item for the
patch panel.
Index
266
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Basic functions
Enter the name for the patch panel and click OK The dialogue for the circuit
description is displayed and asks for the name of the port for the data outlet:
Continue naming the data outlets until all ports are labelled. The process is then configuration
configuration
ended. You can add additional components.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
267
Introduction
tion boards
To create a low-voltage current distribution board (e.g. a telephone switchboard),
follow the procedures described in chapter 11.2, page 239. The product database
contains various types of low-voltage distribution boards and switchboards:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
268
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Distribution boards and switchboards Erro
r!
Configuring a low-voltage distribution board is realised by using the "New Circuit”
(1)
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
After starting with Add or Insert DDS-CAD asks for the cable name.
configuration
configuration
By confirming the name, the cable becomes part of the distribution board. You can
make any necessary adjustments to the cable type afterwards.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
269
Introduction
similar in character, behaviour, and hence their application. For this description, they
are therefore combined under the term "Pipelines" or "Pipeline functions", with
specific differences being taken into account by corresponding notes and sections.
270
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
situation, it is displayed at the start of a new pipeline or when editing an existing
41
one .
The starting height describes the distance between the centre axis of the
pipe/ventilation duct and the top edge of the finished floor. Their definition is only
important when starting in a free point. If the pipeline begins at an object, DDS-CAD
automatically detects the starting height and applies it.
Adjustments,
(A (B (C
41
For example, if you start a pipe at a free point, DDS-CAD does not receive any instructions and you have to define all the
parameters yourself. However, if you begin at the connection point of an object (such as the cold water connection of a wash
basin), it will draw information about the medium and the starting height of the line from said object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
271
Introduction
Default setting: The material and colour of the branching pipeline (A) is determined
by the main pipeline (C). Any possible change is transferred automatically.
The material can be determined by selecting an item. The colour is independent of
the medium and can be selected in the "Attributes” tab.
272
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Dashed The pipeline is represented by dashed lines and no shading. You can
define the shape of the dashed line by setting the length for at most three
Basic functions
Show drawing direction (arrows)
On: The flow direction of the pipes and/or ventilation ducts is
visualised by arrows.
configuration
Pipes and ventilation ducts are passed from one storey to
configuration
another through drawing operations (see 9.3.3.1, page 180). This
results in transfer points, which are set as visible in the storey
being shown and are used to continue the pipeline (see 9.3.1.7,
page 175). The example shows the transition points of various ventilation ducts. You
can see the cross-section and dimension. Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
273
Introduction
Manually drawing pipes and ventilation ducts is indispensable when designing the
network. You can develop a complete network manually without using auxiliary
42
functions , but you cannot use any auxiliary function without having done manual
preparation beforehand. The procedure (using the example of a pipe) always
corresponds to the order shown. The ventilation ducts behave in a similar way:
to T-piece)
At interconnection point
Define endpoint
(End pipe) from adjacent floor
42
e.g. copy sub-networks (9.4.2, page 187) or automatically use connection functions (9.4.4, page 192)
Index
274
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.2.1 Starting point and direction of the first segment
Basic functions
Starting at a bend page 173
(convert bend to tee)
configuration
h
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index configuration
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
275
Introduction
You can define the pipeline's starting point by clicking at any X/Y position. The
start dialogue is displayed and you are given full access to all parameters.
Note
Use this option, for example, to prepare individual pipeline sections and sub-
networks. You can incorporate these later on in your work and complete the
network in stages.
General use
(5) (6)
(4)
Pipeline
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
276
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Notes on the starting options
Free
You enter the height of the starting point (A) in figures in
(B the pipeline's starting dialogue. With the default settings
for the drawing direction, the first segment (B) runs
horizontally without incline or slope. You can determine
the course of the first segment (B) by moving the cursor.
(A
On the ceiling
The starting point (A) is set at the room height. With the
(A (B default settings for the drawing direction, the first
segment (B) runs vertically downwards. DDS-CAD
queries the values for the change in height (see 9.3.2.4,
page 178). The starting point is also a transition point to
the storey above. There you can resume the pipe and
Basic functions
continue it (see 9.3.1.7, page 175).
In the floor
The starting point (A) is at the bottom edge of the floor.
With the default settings for the drawing direction, the first
segment (B) runs vertically upwards. DDS-CAD queries
the values for the change in height (see 9.3.2.4,
page 178). The starting point is also a transition point to
the storey below. There you can resume the pipeline and
configuration
(B continue it (see 9.3.1.7, page 175).
configuration
(A
Notes on the slope (wastewater pipe only)
When working with wastewater pipes, you
can set a slope. This is maintained over
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
277
Introduction
Application
Horizontal pipeline
Basic functions
Pipeline
Vertical pipeline
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
278
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.2.1.3 Branch from horizontal pipeline
(2) (3)
Define position:
On ongoing section
(5)
(1)
Pipeline At the start of line section
(4)
Basic functions
Start the pipeline function (1).
Point to the position of the branch. If the position of the cursor is clear, the pa-
rameters of the pipe are displayed in an information box (2). if the position is not
clear, a menu lists the possible connections (3).
Select the desired connection option by clicking . The "General Tee with re-
ducer” dialogue box is displayed (pipes: see 9.5.2.3, page 200; Ventilation ducts:
see Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Error! Bookmark not
configuration
defined.).
configuration
If necessary, adjust the size of the branch and check the item (4).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
279
Introduction
Application
(1)
Basic functions
Pipeline
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
280
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.2.1.5 Conduit – starting at a box
Application
(1)(2)
Basic functions
Pipeline
(3)
(4)
configuration
configuration
Start the pipeline function.
Point to the object. The object is highlighted. If the position of the cursor at a
specific connection point is definite, the name of the object and medium, size
and height of the connection point are displayed in an information box (1). if the
position is not clear, a menu lists the possible connections (2).
extensions,
extensions,
Select the desired connection option by clicking . The product database is dis-
played. The display is limited to the proposed size of the connection point (3)
and only the corresponding materials are shown.
Choose the material. You can draw the pipeline (4).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
281
Introduction
(1)
Application
Basic functions
Pipeline
282
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.2.2 Drawing the pipeline route
Basic functions
(3)
Example: Segment (3) is to lead to the new fixed point (2) in a certain direction by a
certain length via a 90° bend (1):
(2)
configuration
(3)
configuration
[]
Press []/[]/[]/[]. The key determines the direction. The "Collect Points”
dialogue is displayed.
extensions,
Enter the value in metres (m). A helper line indicates the position of the new
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
283
Introduction
[Shift] + []
Press [Shift] and move the cursor to the border of the obstacle. DDS-CAD de-
tects the intersection. This is the reference for defining the fixed point (2).
Press the arrow keys to specify the direction for the location of the new fixed
point (here [Shift]. The "Relative from snap point" dialogue box appears.
Enter the distance from the reference point to fixed point in metres (m).
Click OK . The operation is finished. You can continue your work.
284
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.2.2.5 Undo last drawing step
Press [backspace] or select the function with the same name in the context
menu. The last fixed point is undone. The function remains active.
While working with installation systems, DDS-CAD checks whether the pipeline
collides with other pipelines. The check is performed over all DDS pipeline
43
functions . The check is performed dynamically while you are drawing.
Basic functions
(2)
(1)
(4)
(3)
configuration
configuration
(5)
A menu (1) is displayed at the cursor, offering three options. Select one of the three
extensions,
options by clicking :
the obstacle. Clicking OK negotiates the obstacle. The next click fixes the
Adjustments,
43
For example, if you are editing the ventilation system with DDS-CAD in addition to the electrical system, you can show the
cable ladders in the ventilation ducts and develop the pipeline route without any collisions.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
285
Introduction
End function The installation system is ended at the current fixed point.
[ESC] The function is ended.
Close and start new The installation system is ended at the current fixed point.
[Enter] The function remains active and you can define the next
starting point.
cent storey.
44
You can end the current installation system by connecting it to an existing system
of the same type.
point". If both systems are at the same height, the connection is made straight away.
If there is a difference in height, a dialogue box asks for the method of height
balancing to be used (see below).
At a segment
Cable ladders and conduits can be connected by being joined to a continuous
45
segment . For cable ladders, a tee is inserted at the connection point. For conduits,
a corresponding outlet is inserted. When approaching the existing installation system,
this will be highlighted. A menu is displayed with the pipeline information and
functions for collision avoidance. Select the pipeline information to establish the
connection.
44
You can only connect a ladder to a ladder, but not to a canal.
45
Cable canals do not have this option.
Index
286
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Basic functions
Height differences are detected by DDS-CAD and reported in a message. To create
the connection, click . A dialogue box is displayed that configures the height
compensation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
287
Introduction
(2)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
Select the starting point of the sub-section (1). In the example, the tee of the
branch has been chosen.
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Extend selection and copy paste tree”. The entire subsequent sub-
section is automatically selected and the dialogue is displayed.
Select the desired option (2).
Use on of the four options to configure how the copied sub-section is pasted. In doing
so, the required settings are enabled. To do this, please read the following sections.
Index
288
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Paste into existing section
(1)
Basic functions
(3)
(6)
configuration
(5)
configuration
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
Select "Insert in existing net same twist”.
Enter the number of copies (2) and the distance (4).
extensions,
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. DDS-CAD expects the insertion point in
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
289
Introduction
(3)
(1)
Basic functions
(5)
(6)
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
290
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Paste into new Z-height (at a free point)
(4)
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
Select the sub-section to be copied (1) and start the copy function. The dialogue
box appears.
Select "Insert one copy at given height".
configuration
configuration
Enter the installation height (3) for the starting point of the new sub-section.
Enter the rotation (4) of the sub-section relative to the original.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. DDS-CAD expect the insertion point.
Click on the insertion point (2). The new sub-section has been inserted at the
selected position with the settings for height and rotation. The function remains
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
291
Introduction
You can incorporate the open end of a sub-section into the overall network in two
ways:
Option A
Start the pipeline function at the open end of the sub-section (as per 9.3.1.2,
page 170).
Draw the continuation of the pipeline to the main line and make the connection in
accordance with 9.3.3.3, page 181.
Option B
Select the open segment of the pipeline
by clicking . The segment is temporarily
converted into a polyline.
Click on the node at the open end of
the segment. You can move the open end
of the segment with the cursor.
Basic functions
292
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
In addition to their specific features and forms of application, all pipeline objects also
share common features. These are described at the beginning for all object types.
Afterwards we will explain the specific features of each separate type.
Bends are always installed in the pipe when drawing and configured automatically in
most cases. Each fixed point that is followed by a new segment after a direction
change is converted into a bend (see 9.3.2.1, page 176). The technical parameters
(material and size) are taken from the pipe used. The geometric parameters (angle
Basic functions
and direction) are determined by the drawing operation.
A manual configuration
may be required in special
cases, for example if no
see 9.5.1.1
suitable drawing operation
is available for the desired
change of direction. In this
case, call the object
dialogue of the bend via
the context menu (click )
configuration
or press [B] (ch. 9.3.2.1,
configuration
page 176).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
293
Introduction
Tees are installed in the pipe network through the following options:
• Automatically when branching from an existing pipeline (see
9.3.1.3, page 171 and 9.3.1.4, page 9.3.1.4)
• Automatically when converting a bend to a tee (see 9.3.1.5,
page 173)
• Manually, when drawing the line (see 9.3.2.1, page 176)
• Individually, by manual insertion (see 9.5.3, page 201)
Tee
Basic functions
see 9.5.1.1
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
12.4.1.3 Reducer
Reducer
Index
294
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.4.2 Manual installation of pipeline objects
(1)
Basic functions
Procedure:
Select the required function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line
shows the "Locate flow segment and press left mouse button” prompt.
Click at the position where the component is to be inserted. The object
dialogue of the component is displayed.
Select the item (1), set the required parameters and click OK . The component
is part of the pipe.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
295
Introduction
The nature of the pipeline functions was described in 9.1.1 (page 155). It was said
that the initial properties of the pipeline are defined in the starting point and that these
can change over the pipeline route – with the exception of the medium. This change
in dimension is effected by corresponding components (e.g. reducers). To change
the material, various aspects of the representation and the insulation, you can divide
the pipeline into sections. If two consecutive segments have identical properties, they
can be merged back together.
(1)
Basic functions
(2)
(3)
(4)
Split pipe
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the "Split a pipe” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message
line shows the following prompt: "Locate flow segment and press left mouse but-
ton”.
Click on the position where the division is to be made (2). The "Start drawing
pipes” dialogue box is displayed.
Uncheck "Associate material / color” (3).
Select the properties (4) for the new pipeline segment.
Click OK . The two pipeline segments have different properties. The operation
is ended.
Index
296
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
If two consecutive line pipeline segments have identical properties, they should be
Basic functions
Both functions operate according to the same principle. You create an entry in the
command list, which defines the status of this position until the next change. The
graphic shows an example:
Insulation
The pipe was been
drawn from left to right.
Command (35) enables
the insulation.
Command (41) disables
configuration
it.
configuration
Linetype:
A ventilation duct is to
be marked as partially
obscured. Command
(45) starts the labelling.
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
297
Introduction
Insulation
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select "Insert insulation” function in the toolbox. The cursor turns into a cross-
hair. The message line shows the following prompt: "Locate flow segment and
press left mouse button”.
Click on the position in the pipe, from which the insulation is to be enabled or
disabled. The "Insulation” dialogue box is displayed.
Configure the insulation and click OK . The selected setting applies from the
selected position in the drawing direction of the pipe. The function remains active
and can be used further along the pipe.
Index
298
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
The procedure for
changing the linetype is
Basic functions
An object must be selected before it can be
edited. In addition to the general selection
functions (see 20.1.2, page 506) there are
two other methods used for editing
pipelines. These mainly ensure the
complete deletion of a section with or
without the branching sub-sections.
To call the function, select the pipeline segment where editing is to start.
configuration
Click . The context menu is displayed.
configuration
Select the desired selection function.
editing.
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
299
Introduction
Move bend...
You can change the route of an installation system by moving the start or end point:
Select the first or last segment by clicking . The
start and/or end point is represented by a solid
square .
Click on the symbol . A context menu is dis-
played.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Node
Editing with The node (in this case the starting point of the
polyline: move line) can only be moved in the flow direction of
the segment. The segment is thus extended or
shortened. If necessary, the direction of the
next bend also changes; its position remains
unchanged. The function starts when you click
the symbol .
Move cable ladder The node (in this case the starting point of the
start line) can be moved in any direction. This may
change the direction and position of the
following bend.
When approaching another pipeline with the same medium, the connection can be made via
a tee.
Index
300
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.6.2.3 Moving/inserting a segment
Segment
Editing with polyline: The segment is shifted in
parallel shift parallel. The function
starts when you click
the symbol
Move pipe insert The segment is split and
you can change the route.
Basic functions
The function "Displace parallel polyline-like” is best described using an example. It is
assumed that the pipeline route is necessary because of a change in the floor plan.
An obstacle is to be circumvented:
Before After
configuration
configuration
Start of the editing
extensions,
extensions,
Select the segment by clicking . The centre point is marked by an open square.
Click on the symbol . The context menu is displayed.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Select "Displace parallel polyline-like”. The cursor moves the two movable ends
of the new sub-segments.
The colour of the movable sub-segments can be black or red. This symbolises the
status of the bends, if a fixed point is defined at the current cursor position.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
301
Introduction
Black The angle of the first bend is equivalent to a commercially available standard
size (15°, 30°, 45° or 60°).
Red The angle of at least one bend differs from the commercially standard sizes.
[ESC]
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The operation is useful for example, to straighten the pipeline route. You can remove
bends without having to break up the pipeline and subsequently repair it.
Before After
However, it is critical that you first define the pipeline segment to be edited and
convert it into a polyline. You can then edit it. At the end of the operation, you need to
resolve the polyline back into individual segments. This procedure is also best
described using an example.
Index
302
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Defining a pipeline segment converting it to a polyline
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
Select the pipeline segment (1).
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Start polyline-like edit”. The separate objects (2) are compiled into a
polyline object and labelled separately in the model (3).
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
(4)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
To edit the example described above, use the "Knoten löschen" (Delete node)
function (4). In this way, you get a visually continuous route (5). However, the
remaining segment is still a polyline. This polyline has to be converted back into a
pipeline.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
303
Introduction
(5)
304
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
12.6.3 Editing moulded parts
Basic functions
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select "Replace with two bends". The "Update bend" dialogue is displayed.
Adjust the distance between the bends and click OK . The single bend has
been replaced by two 45° bends. The operation is ended.
You can merge two 45° bends into one 90° bend.
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
305
Introduction
13.1 Introduction
When working on the electrical installation,
you can choose between two methods of
working.
WM: Basic
Use Application Default Tools
46
See 22.2.2, page 549
Index
306
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
In the "Use Customer
Basic functions
There are three component groups available in DDS-CAD for constructing lighting
systems. These can be used as objects. You can also exchange data between DDS-
CAD and the lighting calculation programs DIALux and Relux. For a simple and
rough calculation use the lighting calculation according to the efficiency method:
configuration
rails, connectors, power feeds, no light source
configuration
(see 13.2.2, page 309)
DDS-CAD 7.3
307
Introduction
are divided in the product database in terms of the installation type (1). This is a
property of the item, which controls the position of the mounting point on the symbol
and the location of the symbol in the room.
2 Flush mounted
Basic functions
3 Pendant
luminaire
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
9 Wall mounted
Index
308
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.2.2 ((Support systems, light rails and strip lights))
All objects of this function are handled as dynamic symbols and include their number
in the part list – including the light rails.
Basic functions
You can choose light rails with a defined length as items (1) or define them freely in
the object dialogue (2). In this case, DDS-CAD automatically inserts an item whose
description does not contain any indication of length (3). Please note this with regard
to the part list. If you are using light rails of different lengths, you should create
specific items for this purpose (see, page xxx).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
309
Introduction
(1)
Basic functions
You can control the mounting height of the lights by adjusting the height of the
suspended ceiling. To do this, select the "Suspended ceiling" mounting type for the
light (1).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Warning!
The suspended ceiling is not taken into account by the subsequent object group
functions or included in the lighting calculations.
Index
310
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.2.4 Lighting calculation using the efficiency method
The lighting calculation according to the efficiency method determines the required
number of lamps in a room or an area to achieve a certain level of illuminance. As a
result of this operation, lamps of the selected type are placed in the model as an
object group.
Warning!
The efficiency method is a rough estimate process that assumes the following
boundary conditions to obtain a realistic result:
cube-shaped room (rectangular floor plan)
ratio of room length to room width between 1.6:1 and maximum 4:1
completely empty room
constant and completely diffuse reflection from the room's boundary surfaces
uniform light flux distribution over each sub-area
uniform arrangement of the lamps in the room
Fluorescent lamps are mounted in the longitudinal direction of the room
Basic functions
Often rooms have a floor plan whose rectangular shape is not ideal and is interrupted
in some places. Therefore, in principle the light calculation in DDS-CAD works in
polygonal rooms. You must decide on an individual basis whether a light calculation
makes sense for the given room geometry or not. The following diagrams illustrate
this point:
configuration
Lighting calculation is fully lighting calculation seems lighting calculation does
configuration
applicable reasonable. not seem reasonable.
(1)
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
311
Introduction
Start from
toolbox
(1)
Basic functions
Lighting
(2)
Lighting calculation with active lamp: You can call a single lamp, configure all of its
properties (item, rotation and attributes) and use it to execute a lighting calculation. If
the cursor moves the lamp as a dynamic symbol, start the lighting calculation via the
context menu (click ).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Starting from the toolbox: You can start the lighting calculation as an independent
function. You define the lamp's properties during the course of the application (see
below).
A wizard is displayed in both cases. It provides three methods (1) with which the
room area to be calculated can be defined.
Select the desired method (1) and click Continue (2). The algorithm of the chosen
method starts and prompts you to input the room data.
Index
312
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.2.4.3 Determining the area to be calculated and inputting the room data
Basic functions
Define a free contour
The area is drawn as a rectangle or
polygon, the lamps are automatically
arranged in the model. After starting:
Click on the first corner of the
room area. The cursor moves a dy-
namic line.
Draw the room (see 19.1.4,
page 439). The "Room Information”
dialogue box is displayed, the size
configuration
has been entered graphically.
configuration
Enter the missing data.
DDS-CAD 7.3
313
Introduction
Call the "Room Information” dialogue box in addition to information about the
technical lighting conditions of the room and the required quality of illumination:
In the "Input product data" dialogue box, specify the lamps used. If you started the
light calculation from the context menu of the active lamp (see 13.2.4.2, page 312),
DDS-CAD automatically transfers all properties. Check and correct the settings:
314
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.2.4.6 Product placement (lights)
Basic functions
The calculated lamps are parts of an object group (box). You can perform the
calculation again later on and print the calculation results:
Select a lamp. The object is shown dark, all are displayed light blue.
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Choose "Select group". All objects are displayed in dark blue.
Click again. The context menu is displayed.
Select “Edit Properties”. The "Room Information” dialogue box is displayed.
configuration
Next (1) starts the calculation routine
configuration
again, Print (2) generates a report.
(2) extensions,
extensions,
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Report Contents
EL_Lightcalculation.rpt Log with information about the room, desired design values,
data about the lamp and calculation results.
EL_Lightcalculation_as_list.rpt List of all lighting calculations in the project with the data for
the lighting calculation in abbreviated form.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
315
Introduction
After the project has been completed and saved in DIALux or Relux, switch back to
DDS-CAD. Open the transfer files again, connect the lamps from the transfer file to a
Basic functions
lamp in the DDS product database and have the lamps incorporated into the model.
From the perspective of DDS-CAD, DIALux and Relux differ in that DIALux can
handle several rooms whereas Relux can only handle a single room. In both cases,
the interfaces are operated along the same principle, but DIALux offers more options.
Therefore we shall describe the rest of the procedure using the DIALux interface as
an example.
(1)
(2)
(3)
DIALux Conversion
Start the "DIALux Conversion Utility” function. The "Export and Import STF for
DIALux" dialogue box is displayed. You can transfer all rooms to DIALux or just
individual ones (1)/(2).
Select the desired function (you have to specify a single room by clicking ).
The transfer file has been written to the project folder. The dialogue remains
open. You can start the lighting calculation.
Click Open STF in DIALux . The calculation program starts and opens the exported
data.
Index
316
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Carry out the lighting design in the calculation program and save your work. The
calculation program enters information about the lamps used and their positions
Note:
If you need information about DIALux or Relux, please refer to the documentation
for the respective system or contact customer support.
The calculation program has added to the transfer file. Information about the lamps
used (lamp type) and their positions in the model have been entered into the file.
Each lamp type from the transfer file must now be connected to a lamp from the DDS
product database. We recommend that you create your own items in order to capture
the actual lamps used in the parts list (for information on creating your own articles,
see 22.2.3, page 538).
Switch back to DDS-CAD and start the "DIALux Conversion Utility" function. The
"Export and Import STF for DIALux" dialogue box is displayed.
Click Open STF file (1). The table lists all the lamps that have been used in the
Basic functions
calculation program for this project.
(2)
(1)
(3)
Select a lamp from the transfer file (in this case DIAL 1 SiNOVA). configuration
configuration
Select the component type (2) and click … (3). The product database is dis-
extensions,
played.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
317
Introduction
(4)
(5)
(6)
Repeat this step for all lamps. You can transfer all rooms to DIALux or just indi-
vidual ones (5)/(6).
Select the desired function (you have to specify a single room by clicking ).
The lamps are at the specified positions in the model.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
318
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
DDS-CAD ETS
Basic functions
Notes on the building model
The building structure is
DDS-CAD ETS required to transfer the project
to ETS. The names of the
storeys are taken from the
drawings list. The room names
come from the building model.
Only the room contours are
needed to exchange data.
Doors, windows, roofs and other
building elements are irrelevant
configuration
to this application purpose (cf.
configuration
chapter 5.2.1, page 49).
extensions,
extensions,
KNX systems
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
319
Introduction
If you have used all KNX components for the planned system, export the objects for
ETS. DDS-CAD generates an XML file, whose name can be chosen freely. The first
processing stage in DDS-CAD is now complete:
Select "File "Export" (Export) and then the
"Export KNX objects for ETS" function.
• Topology
• Building
• Group addresses
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
320
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Import data from DDS-CAD into ETS
Basic functions
uct. Confirm the allocation
with OK . The query for the
(3) next KNX object is displayed.
Repeat the allocation until the
query no longer appears. The
project has been transferred to
ETS. The KNX components are
displayed in the "Topologie" (To-
pology) and "Building Informa-
tion” windows with no physical
configuration
address:
components receive
their physical
addresses.
If you have finished designing the system in ETS, you can save the result in a
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
321
Introduction
Select the "Insert” menu "File" and then the "Import KNX devices" function.
The "Open" dialogue box is displayed.
Select the file that you
created previously with
ETS. This opens the
"Administrator" dialogue
box and shows the topol-
ogy of the system and
the position of the com-
ponents in the building.
Click Close . The data
have been transferred to
the KNX objects in the
entire project.
(2)
Index
322
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.3.2 Data exchange between DDS-CAD and ELVIS
Export perspectives
Basic functions
For a high-quality
visualisation, you
should prepare the
model in DDS-CAD, so
that the visual impact is
satisfactory.
configuration
configuration
• correct positions of the components (correct height, objects for wall mounting
must be placed on the wall line).
• the complete building model with windows and doors. Furnishings (e.g. furniture)
are not transferred, but they can be simulated by geometric shapes.
extensions,
• possibly design of other DDS application types. If you have also modelled the
extensions,
heating, plumbing, and ventilation systems with DDS-CAD, you can display these
models.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
323
Introduction
324
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Exporting perspectives
The export is done for all storeys together in one step. It does not matter what storey
Basic functions
Starting Elvis and creating the project
Create a new project in Elvis. A wizard guides you
through the process.
Importing a 3D model
To import the transfer file
from DDS-CAD:
configuration
configuration
Go to the Project
Folder Explorer and
click on the "Pages"
folder (1). The context
(1) menu is displayed.
(2) Select "Add" "Import
extensions,
3D model". The
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
325
Introduction
Folder Explorer. For further editing, use the files which bear the name of the imported
file and just one extra digit. The digit (here 0; 1; 2) is the label for the storey and is
taken from the DDS drawings list. Open this file by double clicking .
Basic functions
An opened file in Elvis displays the model from the first saved perspective
(Camera1). All saved perspectives are arranged as Camera 1 to Camera n at the
bottom of the screen. You can use the Elvis server to switch between the
47
perspectives . All lamps are listed on the left-hand side. The label contains the
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
name of the room in which the object is located and the name of the DDS symbol file.
The top edge contains all other possible data points.
47
Press [Ctrl]+[F5]. The server starts (which can take several seconds). You can then view the visualisation from the saved
perspectives.
Index
326
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
Timing devices
FDS area
Basic functions
All objects are treated as dynamic symbols. This chapter describes specific features
of data equipment and fire alarm systems.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
327
Introduction
The associated auxiliary object visually consists of a rectangle the size of the
placeholder. In order to not distort the part list as a result of the combination, you
should also disable the quantification of the auxiliary objects (1).
(1)
RJ45
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
You can now assign a line to each auxiliary symbol. Use the combination as a
template to place additional data outlets.
Index
328
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.4.1.2 Data sockets in the floor duct
(1)
Basic functions
(1)
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
Pay attention to the correct mount height, enable snap points and fix the objects in
the centre of the installation spot. You can then assign a line to each object. Use the
combination as a template to place additional data outlets.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
329
Introduction
The objects of fire alarm systems and the identification of monitoring areas is
performed by two different component groups.
To call the fire alarm, select the "Fire and Security" function. You
get access to the technical components of the hazard detection
equipment:
max. distance
point ceiling-detector
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
330
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.4.3 Numbering fire alarms
PositionMarker
(1)
Basic functions
(2) 1
3
(3)
configuration
configuration
Select the "PositionMarker” function. The dialogue box (see above) is displayed.
Select the type (1), prefix (2) and the number (3) for the first component and click
OK . The cursor turns into a crosshair.
extensions,
Use your mouse to point to the first component to be identified. The component
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
331
Introduction
13.5.1 Introduction
All objects in the electrical installation include the tabs "Connected” and “Text” in their
object dialogue. The information contained in "Connected” is presented taking into
account the symbol text settings for the symbol.
(2)
(1)
UV01.1
Basic functions
The example shows the symbol of a fluorescent lamp with its label. All relevant fields
under "Connected” (1) have been filled out. However, according to “Text” (2)
distribution board ID and circuit ID are retrieved.
This section deals with the allocation of circuit information to the individual objects, in
other words filling out the "Connected” tab. Essentially this can be done by two
different methods. You can enter the label manually or apply it as a result of
connecting an electrical line from the distribution board to the object.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
For pure labelling, DDS-CAD does not require a meticulously drawn line, and no
drawing-related connection between distribution board and connected objects is
necessary. You can draw a minor line (e.g. small cross-sections) temporarily from
component to component. However, if the lines are significant for the part list, they
must be laid correctly.
332
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.2 Methods of
UV01.1 UV01.1
UV01.1 UV01.1
Basic functions
UV01.1
Select several (or all) components that belong to the same circuit.
configuration
configuration
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select “Edit Properties”. The "ElpSymSymbol" dialogue box is displayed.
Switch to the "Connected” tab.
Enter the data and confirm with OK .
extensions,
You reach the dialogue box for setting object properties. The components are
extensions,
However, this method is not suitable if you are designing the distribution boards in
DDS-CAD. In this case, we recommend the second method.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
333
Introduction
This method aims to identify connected objects AND correctly detect cable lengths
for the part list. Measured against the two other methods, it involves greater effort
and requires some practice. Having said this, the "Start Trunk” function is a tool
available that can make this work much easier. Therefore you should weigh effort
and benefits against each other and find a good balance.
Basic functions
SV01.2
Index
334
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.2.5 Opening the distribution board and starting the cable
Double click
(1)
Circuit List
(2)
Check the description of the circuit, and correct if necessary: Double click on
the cell of the description. The dialogue box is displayed.
Correct the circuit description and click OK . The dialogue box is closed.
Click Draw . The parameters settings dialogue box is displayed.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Check and correct the settings and click OK . The cursor turns into a cross-
hair. You can draw the cable.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
335
Introduction
This method aims to identify connected objects AND correctly detect cable lengths
for the part list. Measured against the two other methods, it involves greater effort
and requires some practice. Having said this, the "Start Trunk” function is a tool
available that can make this work much easier. Therefore you should weigh effort
and benefits against each other and find a good balance.
SV01.2
Index
336
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.4 Drawing the cable harnesses
Basic functions
During the subsequent cable installation,
you do not have to draw every line from
SV01 DV01 the distribution board to the terminal
device. Instead, you can enable the
distribution board and the cable in
accordance with Hiba! A hivatkozási
configuration
forrás nem található. and call on the
configuration
cable harness at any point. However,
UV01 mathematically the cable begins in its
distribution board and automatically takes
the prescribed installation route.
M UV01.3
extensions,
extensions,
RJ45
DV01.1.1-1
DV01.1.1-2
DV01.1.1-3
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
SV01.2
48
In small units with star-shaped cable installations, the cable harness does not add much value.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
337
Introduction
Click . The cursor moves a movable line that you can guide in any direction.
Start drawing. Each mouse click defines a break point.
You want to build a system of cable harnesses. To do this, existing cable harnesses
must be branched.
Point (without clicking) to the cable harness:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Press [F2]. The cursor moves a movable line that you can guide in any direc-
tion. Start drawing. Each mouse click defines a break point.
Index
338
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.4.4 Drawing the path of the cable harness
If the cursor gets close to a distribution system, the program snaps the cursor with
the cable harness and holds it tight.
Basic functions
To establish the connection, click .
configuration
distribution system.
configuration
Check the description of the circuit, and correct if necessary:
Double click on the cell of the description. The dialogue box
is displayed.
Correct the circuit description and click OK . The dialogue
box is closed. The circuit description in the cell has been
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
339
Introduction
You want to start the cable at a component (e.g. switches, sockets, lamp or
distribution boards, etc.).
Point to the component. The component appears as a selected object:
You have prepared a system of cable harnesses. The cable is to start at the harness
in terms of the drawing and in the distribution mathematically.
Point (without clicking) to the cable harness:
Basic functions
Press [F2]. The cursor moves a movable line that you can guide in any direc-
tion. Start drawing. Each click defines a break point.
Horizontal installation
Each click fixes the line at the position of the cursor.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
If the cursor gets close to a symbol, the program snaps the cursor with the cable and
holds it tight.
To establish the connection, click . The component receives a circuit label.
Index
340
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.6 Installation spanning several storeys
Basic functions
For both situations the same fact applies that the drawing operation only refers to one
storey. In the first case, the target of the cable guidance exists, but the starting point
is missing. For the second case, the reverse situation applies. The starting point is
configuration
available, but the target of the cable guidance is located in another storey.
configuration
In terms of the lines drawn, there are no connections between the storeys. However,
we recommend making each relevant storey visible in order to visualise the positions
of the desired starting or target points as well as the differences in height. extensions,
In the following sections, we describe how to show a storey and how to process
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
341
Introduction
The "Inserted file administrator" dialogue box appears. This lists all storeys (2)
belonging to the active project and the selected application type (1) under the
tab “Complete List of All Model in the Project". Storeys with the symbol are
invisible. Storeys with the symbol are visible.
(1
)
(2
)
Basic functions
Click once on the symbol of the relevant storey. The symbol changes to
and further settings (3) are enabled:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Note:
It is useful to use different colours
to distinguish between the different storeys:
Uncheck "Default” at ”Pen”
and choose a different colour for each storey.
Click OK . The storey with the distribution board is visible. By switching to the
front or side view, you can determine the mounting height of the distribution
board from the perspective of the current storey.
Index
342
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.6.2 Situation 1 – a distribution system supplies several consumers
Basic functions
to be drawn horizontally for the part list.
By showing the storey (where the
distribution board is located) you can
determine the required mounting height.
configuration
to 13.5.4, page 337 for more information.
configuration
(3)
extensions,
extensions,
Show the storey where the distribution board is located. You can see the position
of the distribution board and determine the difference in height via the front and
side views.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
343
Introduction
In the "Insert” menu select the "Storey Pointer” function. The product database is
displayed. The "Storey Pointer" filter is active.
Select the desired item. The "Connection Devices” dialogue box is displayed:
(1)
Basic functions
Adjust the mounting height (1) so that the height difference to the position of the
distribution system can be overcome by the cabling guidance and click OK .
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the distribution board, which is represented by this feedthrough and then
click OK . The starting point of the cabling installation is defined. The cursor
moves the cable harness as a dynamic line.
Start by constructing the cable harness and note the installation height when do-
ing so. All heights refer to the current storey. The upper edge of the finished floor
corresponds to the height 0.
Index
344
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Lightning protection and earthing systems Erro
r!
13.5.6.3 Situation 2 – One main distribution system supplies sub-distributions
on the storeys
Procedure:
Show the storey where the sub-board to be supplied is located. You can see the
Basic functions
position of the distribution board and determine the difference in height via the
front and side views.
Select the main distribution
Call the "Supply line to sub-distribution..." circuit for drawing.
Start the line at the main distribution system, lead this to the riser point and
change the installation height to reach the sub-distribution.
Connect the cable to the sub-distribution and end the function with [ESC].
Hide the storey of the sub-distribution.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
345
Introduction
and a coordinate
plane. Now the
required distribution
board has to be
activated:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3)
(2)
(1)
Select the "Circuit List” function. The "Define board” dialogue box is displayed.
Select the desired distribution board (1) or create a new one (2). The distribution
board is active.
Activate the sheet list (3).
Index
346
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Building and system schematics Erro
r!
14.2 Managing sheetsand navigating between them
Basic functions
You can edit the list of available sheets by changing the information, entering
revisions or deleting pages.
Select a single sheet (click ) or several sheets ([Ctrl]+ ).
Click on the selected sheet. A context menu is displayed.
configuration
sheet information. The modified information is
configuration
displayed in the list of available sheets and in the text
fields of each individual sheet.
Delete The selected sheets are deleted
Local revision You can generate an a revision entry that only appears
of the selected in the text fields of the selected sheets.
sheets
extensions,
extensions,
49
The contents of this list depend on the license. It may be the case that not all templates shown are available.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
347
Introduction
You can switch from one sheet to the next with the "Previous sheet” and "Next sheet"
functions. The status bar shows you the number of the current sheet and the number
of available sheets. The example shows sheet 1 of 5 (1). In addition, the name of the
current sheet (2) is displayed.
Previous sheet
Basic functions
Next sheet
(1) (2)
Add sheet
Index
348
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Building and system schematics Erro
r!
Basic functions
(draw circuit from ... to). Sheet limits are not exceeded.
On sheet 1
(1)
configuration
Draw circuits
configuration
extensions,
extensions,
Select "Draw circuits” (1). The "Draw circuits” dialogue box is displayed.
Enter the interval for sheet 1. For the address, simply select the name of a re-
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
349
Introduction
(1)
Draw circuits
Add the next sheet with the "Blank sheet and DC" function. DDS-CAD creates
the new sheet and the "Draw circuits” dialogue box is automatically displayed.
Basic functions
Insert point
Select the "Insert point” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Click on the position where the first circuit is to be displayed.
Draw the circuits.
Index
350
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Building and system schematics Erro
r!
14.4 Drawing manually
(2)
(1) (3)
Figure diagram
(4)
(5)
Basic functions
Each of these components has the character of objects. If a device consists of
several components that can be separately as symbols (e.g. a contactor) the
available types of symbols is displayed in the selection dialogue.
"Name" (1) lists all previously defined objects in the active component group.
New (2) creates a new object for the active component group. You are taken to the
selection in the product database.
Copy (3) duplicates the current object with all settings, parameters, and additional
configuration
auxiliary functions.
configuration
Rename (4) opens a dialogue to configure the contact IDs.
Aux. contacts (5) creates an additional auxiliary function for the current object. So for
You can only place each component of a device (e.g. the contactor coil) once in the
extensions,
drawing. It shall only be released again after having been deleted from the drawing.
DDS-CAD 7.3
351
Introduction
You can use the "Insert Terminal” function to configure the terminal. Specify the
name of the terminal block and the number of terminals.
Insert Terminal
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
352
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Building and system schematics Erro
r!
Basic functions
Select the circuit by clicking . The selected circuit is displayed as a selected
object and is highlighted in bold. All other circuits are also selected, but appear
pale.
Select the "Circuit List” function. The distribution board database is displayed.
The entry for the selected circuit is also highlighted in the table.
How can you recognise the circuits of the open sheet in the distribution board
database?
configuration
The circuits of the
configuration
open sheet are
highlighted in the
table by italic text.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
353
Introduction
You are looking at an entry in the distribution board database and want to go to the
sheet where the item is located. The circuit of interest is not on the current sheet (text
is not in italics). The drawn circuit is to be viewed in its own sheet:
Select the row by clicking . The row is selected. The context menu is dis-
played.
Select the
"Goto single Multiline
sheet for circuit or
"Goto Singleline sheet
for circuit" function.
DDS-CAD opens the
sheet where this circuit
was drawn.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
354
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Emergency and evacuation routes Erro
r!
15 Emergency and evacuation routes
Emergency routes
The " Escape routes" and "Broken line for Escpae routes"
functions are used as a dynamic line. After opening the
Basic functions
function, define the starting point, the vertices and the end
of the route by clicking . Afterwards, close the function by
pressing [ESC].
The "Direction" function is effected as a symbol.
Immediately after opening the function, the cursor controls
the symbol of an arrowhead.
configuration
configuration
Highlighting fire walls and fire compartments
All functions are used as a dynamic line. After opening the
function, define the starting point, the vertices and the end
of the highlighting by clicking . Afterwards, close the
function by pressing [ESC].
extensions,
extensions,
Object grid
The object grid is effected as cross-hatching. After opening
the function, define the contours of the area by clicking .
Afterwards, close the function by pressing [ESC].
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
355
Introduction
When working with DDS-CAD you develop the virtual model of the system. From this
you can derive graphical representations in various forms, which you can print out on
paper or output to a data exchange format (PDF, DWG/DXF). For quantitative
analysis, create a parts list that you can use in different ways.
Scal e !:100
Edited
Chec ked
Status
New office building
Ground floor
Modific ati on
Basic functions
Heating – Piping
SS0912 Copper pipes, rods 5m 18x1 12.50m
SS0913 Copper pipes, rods 5m 22x1 23.85m
356
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
In the "Tools” menu "Part Models / Sections select the "Help for Defini-
extensions,
tions" function. The product database is displayed and opens a filter containing
various tools for designing part drawings for a variety of applications.
Call the subframe for the required size. The subframe is displayed at the cursor
as a dynamic symbol.
Adjustments,
Fix the subframe in the drawing to symbolise the position and size of the required
Adjustments,
part drawings.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
357
Introduction
Part
(1)
(3)
(4)
(2)
Basic functions
Select the "Part drawings” function. The administration dialogue lists all part
drawings in the model (1). The selected part drawing is displayed in the preview.
Click New (2). The "List of part drawings" dialogue box is displayed.
Name and describe the part drawing (3).
Select the type of the part drawing: "Rectangle" or "Polygon" (4).
Click OK . You can define the geometry of the part drawing.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
358
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.1.3 Copying a part drawing definition
Basic functions
context menu. To do this, click on the entry in the list.
configuration
Menu item Function
configuration
Zoom Displays the contents of the part drawing magnified on the screen.
Properties Opens the "Auschnitt" (Part drawing) dialogue. You can edit the name
and description.
Delete Removes the part drawing from the list and the model
Export Exports the contents of the part drawing as DWG, DXF, 3DS, or CFI.
extensions,
Create Creates a new presentation (see 3.3.2.3, page 27), which only
extensions,
presentation displays the contents of the part drawing and which can be used as a
work area.
Print Starts the print function for the part drawing
New Starts the algorithm to generate a new part drawing.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
359
Introduction
Sections
(1)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3)
(4)
(5)
(2)
Select the "Sections” function. The dialogue box lists all sections present in the
model (1). The part drawing selected in the list is displayed in the preview.
Click New . The "List of sections" dialogue box is displayed.
Define the label for the intersection line (4) and use "Description” to enter addi-
tional text information.
Click OK . The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the fol-
lowing prompt: "Specify section position".
Index
360
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
Defining an intersection line and ending the definition
After starting the function, you can
Offset intersection lines are divided into sections, where you can adjust the section
depth individually once the operation has been completed. The procedure for section
B-B is:
Basic functions
(1) (2) (3)
[Enter]
configuration
configuration
Start the section definition. The following prompt is displayed: "Specify section
position”.
Click on the starting point of the intersection line (1). The cursor moves the
movable end of the intersection line. Section symbols and a predefined section
extensions,
depth are visible.
extensions,
Click on the first vertex in the path of the intersection line (2). One flow seg-
ment is finished. You can continue the intersection line.
Define the remaining segment up to the end point by clicking (3/4).
Press [Enter] (5). The definition is complete. The "Sections” dialogue box is
Adjustments,
displayed.
Adjustments,
Define additional sections or close the dialogue. The last defined section (6) is
displayed as the selected object. You can correct the section depth.
DDS-CAD 7.3
361
Introduction
362
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.2.2 Managing sections
Basic functions
16.3 Working with print layouts
16.3.1 Creating a new print layout
The print layout is the work area where you can
combine the desired views (complete model views,
part drawings and sections) with layout elements
(frame, title field, legends, etc.). You create a print
configuration
layout from a presentation of the working model (1).
configuration
You can either work manually or use a wizard.
Scal e !:100
Edited
Chec ked
Status New office
b ildi floor
Ground
Modific ati on
(3)
(1)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
(2)
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
363
Introduction
for the intended name (3), which you can enter freely. After confirming with OK the
work area is created and you are taken to the user interface. Then you develop the
layout.
(2)
(1) (3)
Chapter 19.2
Page 462
364
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.3.3 Inserting a model/part drawing/section
Basic functions
Select "Model/part drawing/section". The dialogue box is displayed.
Select the desired element (1). It is displayed in the preview.
Define the size as a scale ratio or factor (2). The other value is automatically re-
calculated.
Click Insert (3). The element can be used as a dynamic symbol.
configuration
configuration
16.3.4 Inserting sheets, title fields and legends
When using the wizard, the
querying and arrangement of
sheet and title field takes place
automatically. If you are
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
365
Introduction
Sheets
(2) (1) You determine the size of the sheet by
selecting the item (1). Its settings are
transferred to Input "Length" and Input
“Width” (2). You can edit these values
manually and adjust the sheet size.
Title field/stamp
The product database (3) contains
several differently designed title fields for
different purposes (for information on
(4) (5) creating your own title fields, please refer
(3) to 23.7 page 584).
If you have previously used a sheet from
the DDS product database, the title field
is automatically assigned to the right or
left lower corner (4). With these settings,
the title field corrects its position
automatically when you change the
Basic functions
The text in the title field are automatically transferred from the project, drawing and
revision data (see 16.3.5, page 366). By default, the information of the current model
is displayed. If necessary, you can retrieve the information of another model (5). To
do this, enter the ID of the desired drawing. You can find this number in the drawings
list.
Legends
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The construction of a title field is explained in Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Hiba! A könyvjelző nem
50
366
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
Access is gained via the
toolbox or via the "Project and
Project data
This is where you can enter
global data – in other words,
information relating to all the
drawings in the project. These
include the project description,
project number and address,
for example. You can browse
through the dialogue using the
Back and Next (1) functions.
This takes you to the previous
and next text fields.
Drawing data
Basic functions
(1) Drawing data are specific
information that only affects the
current print layout. The
description of the drawing
content, scale ratio, editors and
data are typical examples. This
is also where you will find the
functions Back and Next (2)
to scroll through the dialogue.
Revision data
configuration
Use the revision data to
configuration
document changes. DDS-CAD
records a continuous list for
each model. To create a new
(2)
revision entry:
(2).
(3)
Click New (3). The "Revision"
dialogue box is displayed.
Check all details and click
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
367
Introduction
(1) (2)
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
368
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.5 Part list
Basic functions
Building model with system
Beis6001.BOQ.zip
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
369
Introduction
The part list can be used to output automatically and differently configured
evaluations. In this context, the term "report" is used. A report can be printed via the
default printer or exported to various file formats (e.g. Excel, HTML, XML or CSV).
Basic functions
Note
The following pages describe the contents of the respective reports.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the desired report by double clicking . The report is created. The taskbar
at the bottom of the screen shows the button with the symbol:
Click this button. The print preview is displayed. You can choose to printout on
the active default printer (1) or choose a format for data export (2):
(1)(2)
Index
370
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.5.2.2 Parts list sorted by product groups
BQ_Partslist.rpt
Basic functions
16.5.2.3 Part list by inclusion in rooms
You will receive an evaluation in which the materials used are broken according to
which room they are located in. To use this report it is necessary that you have
constructed the building model (see chapter 5). Objects with the "piece" unit of
quantity are counted according to the position of their insertion point in a room. For
configuration
objects with the metre (m) unit of quantity, the following rules apply:
configuration
Pipeline
Cable ladders, cable canals, conduits, pipes and ventilation ducts are counted toward
the room in which the start of the pipeline is located.
are counted toward the room in which the last electrical connection is located.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
371
Introduction
BQ_Partslist by rooms.rpt
Basic functions
372
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.5.2.4 Material allowances by rooms
Basic functions
BQ_Partslist by rooms for quantity survey.rpt
Adjustments,
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
373
Introduction
BQ_ELP_INS_Kabelliste.rpt
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The report consists of a cover sheet with the project details as well as the lists of
lines to be installed.
Index
374
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Rendering – Image synthesis from the model Erro
r!
16.5.2.6 Output as a text file (to a text editor)
By
adjusting a structural setting (2)
Basic functions
you can filter the part list in various
ways. Assessments of individual
material groups and layers are
possible (4). You can also sort the
part list in three levels according to
various criteria.
Click Editor (2). The selected
program starts and opens the
part list as an editable docu-
ment.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
375
Introduction
DDS-CAD can either display the quantities in a part list or compare two part lists to
each other. The decisive factor here is the status of "Compare with revision” (1).
The comparison templates are managed in a separate dialogue box. Click Revision (2).
The "Compare Two Revisions” dialogue box is displayed:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
New creates a new comparison template. The dialogue box for entering a name is
displayed. DDS-CAD saves the current part list along with the date and time. All
available comparison templates are listed in "Comparison the part list with this
revision). The comparison is always against the active revision.
376
DDS-CAD 7.3
DDS-CAD 7.3
functions
377
Part III – Reference to the DDS basic
Reference to the DDS basic functions
Index
Index Adjustments,
Adjustments,extensions, configuration
extensions, configuration Basic functions Strategies for handling projects Introduction
Introduction
270°
Index
378
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.2 Grid
Basic functions
The location of the grid, its rotation and the distances between grid points are
variable. You can:
configuration
• enable/disable the grid (see 17.3.1, page 384)
configuration
• snap the grid to a point (see 17.2.1, page 380)
• define the distances between the grid points (see 17.2.2, page 381)
• rotate the grid/coordinate plane (see 17.2.3, page 382)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
379
Introduction
Example situation
You need a grid that is oriented to a corner of the room. The origin of the grid is
situated so that there is no grid point at the desired position. You need to align the
grid to a new reference point.
Basic functions
Application
In the "Format" menu select "Grid settings” and the "Grid origo 1 point" function.
The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the following prompt:
"Specify origin".
Move the cursor to the point at which the grid is to be aligned. The point captures
the cursor and holds it tight. The coordinates are displayed.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click . The origin of the grid is located at the selected position. The function is
ended.
Index
380
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.2.2 Defining distances between the grid points
(2)
Basic functions
(1)
Application
In the "Format" menu select "Grid settings” and select a predefined setting (1) or
the "Grid ?x?x?" function (2).
(1) The grid points immediately change their setting.
(2) The "Grid Settings" dialogue box is displayed. You can define the distances
in the X- and Y-directions.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
381
Introduction
The rotation of the grid may be necessary before or during the application of a
function.
382
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
Application – rotating the coordinate system
Reset grid
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
Click the first end of the reference line (2).
The cursor moves a dynamic line (3). (4)
Click the second end of the reference line
(4). The active function is continued with a ro-
tated coordinate system. You can execute the
desired drawing operation (5). (5)
The "Reset grid" function activates the start-
ing position. You can continue working at right
angles (6).
configuration
(6)
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index configuration
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
383
Introduction
"Snap to Grid” is ON
If the cursor gets close to a grid point, it is caught and held. The
current position is displayed. This method is useful for example,
when editing circuit diagrams and schematics where the objects
have to be arranged uniformly.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
384
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.3.2 Snap areas
Basic functions
"Surface Mode” is ON
The two-dimensional plane between the X and Y axis (1) is ignored and the
reference plane is redefined by the current cursor position. The example shows a
pitched roof in plan view, on which there is a group of PV modules.
(3)
(4)
configuration
X
configuration
X
In the picture on the left the upper area has been activated. In the right-hand picture
extensions,
extensions,
it is the lower area. The active area is surrounded by a wide green line (3). The local
coordinate system of this surface is visualised by a black dot for its origin (4), a
narrow red line for the X-axis (5) and a narrow green line (6) for the Y-axis. Its
rotation depends on the active area. In the left-hand picture it is consistent with the
general two-dimensional plane. In the right-hand picture it is rotated 180° relative to
the two-dimensional plane.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
51
More information on using the lighting calculation (see 13.2.4, page 319) or on working with object groups (see 18.3.2,
page 430.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
385
Introduction
386
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.3.3 Automatic rotation while holding the Ctrl key
Basic functions
"Use Automatic Rotation” is OFF
The symbol captures the lines and rotates so that it is at right
angles.
configuration
The option monitor the geometry of objects. For the purposes of
configuration
this function, the ends and midpoints of lines and intersection points
between two lines are classed as a point. For example, the corners
of rooms and objects in this context should be regarded as
endpoints and intersection points.
The points are ignored and you can move the object freely.
extensions,
In the case of a polyline, consider also that when the active line
meets an existing line, the perpendicular is taken. The position of
the intersection point is calculated so that the two lines meet at
right angles to each other.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
387
Introduction
The option monitors the logic within objects that have connection
possibilities for pipeline functions (e.g. electrical cables, pipes,
ventilation ducts). In this sense for example, electrical components,
sanitary facilities, ventilation units, and also the pipeline functions
themselves are all classed as objects.
If the cursor gets close to the object, this snaps the cursor in. DDS-CAD checks the
existing connection points in the object and – if the object has multiple connection
Basic functions
points – shows its properties in a list. You can select the desired connection from the
list and start the pipeline at this location.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
388
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
Basic functions
Camera
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
Render
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Note
In order to better be able to illustrate the contents of a view, the examples of the
front and side views, the back and the renderings are shown without hidden lines.
In fact, however, all views appear as a transparent model (cf. isometric).
52
You enable to "Render" view by calling the corresponding working mode (see Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található.,
page Hiba! A könyvjelző nem létezik.).
53
Objects, select, delete, move, edit etc.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
389
Introduction
symbols to represent the objects. On the other hand, the various views of the 3D
views show all objects as solid bodies. With regard to navigation in a view, we have
to distinguish between three groups:
• Plan view, front and side view, isometric (see 17.4.2, page 390)
• Camera (see 17.4.3, page 391)
• Render (see Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Error!
Bookmark not defined.)
Zooming with the mouse (always works – even when a function is active)
Function/shortcut Description
(Scroll up) Enlarge image (Zoom into the picture). Cursor
determines the focus
(Scroll down) Reduce image (Zoom out from the picture)
Cursor determines the direction of movement of the
image.
Click, hold and move mouse: Zoom in – select section. The cursor turns into a
magnifying glass. You can drag a window to
determine the screen content.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Zooming with keyboard shortcuts (does not work with active functions)
Function/shortcut Description
[Ctrl]+ [PgUp] Reduce image (Zoom out from the picture)
[Ctrl]+ [PgDn] Enlarge image (Zoom into the picture)
[Ctrl]+ [Home] Zoom all
[Ctrl]+ [End] Limit zoom
[Shift]+[W] Zoom window. The cursor turns into a magnifying
glass. You can click, hold and drag a window over
the desired screen content.
Index
390
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.4.2.2 Slide image (Pan)
Panning with the mouse (always works – even when a function is active)
Function/shortcut Description
Click, hold and move mouse: Slide image. The cursor turns into a hand. You can
move the image over the screen like a sheet of paper.
Panning with keyboard shortcuts (does not work with active functions)
Function/shortcut Description
[Ctrl]+[Shift]+[]/[]/[]/[] The observer moves over the image in small
Basic functions
increments in the specified direction
[Ctrl]+[]/[]/[]/[] The observer moves over the image in large
increments in the specified direction
configuration
configuration
(1)
(3)
extensions,
(2)
Adjustments,extensions,
For navigation, you can correct the viewpoint (1), change the distance to the focus (3)
Adjustments,
54
Another name is "vanishing point perspective". You perceive the model in a realistically distorted form, in which parallel
planes intersect behind the model in a common vanishing line.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
391
Introduction
Click the scroll wheel and hold it down (without scrolling). The mouse pointer
symbol changes. The crossed ellipses symbolise an orbit.
Move the mouse. The model on the screen moves with the mouse. The distance
to the focus remains unchanged.
Select the "Find layers of lines in drawing and turn them off” function. The cursor
turns into a crosshair.
Point to an element in the drawing whose layer you would like to hide. Number
and name of the layer are displayed as information.
Click . The layer is hidden.
Click . The context menu appears and lists all hidden layers. In this way you
can re-activate each layer.
Index
392
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General principles and tools Erro
r!
17.5.1.2 Switch layer in a list
Layer Display
Basic functions
(2)
configuration
Switching the property of multiple layers simultaneously:
configuration
Select the relevant layers. To do this, hold [Ctrl] or [Shift] and select the lay-
ers by clicking .
Click on the property of the selected layer. A context menu is displayed. You
can set or invert the setting for all selected layers.
extensions,
In the event that you need to frequently switch between multiple configurations of
layers switched on and off, you can save time by storing each configuration as a set
(2).
Create the desired layer configuration.
Adjustments,
Click Save . The layer configuration has been saved. You can call it again at any
time.
Switchable properties
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
393
Introduction
394
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18 Objects – Building blocks of the model
Object Display
Graphic icon
Icon text:
Free beaming fluorescent lamp
2x36 W
UV1.1
Basic functions
Distribution
board
UV01
Item
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
Dimensions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
The object uses an item that it takes from the product database. The item's data
record stipulates the symbol to be used, the technical parameters and – in the case
of lamps – the dimensions. The symbol is therefore a property of the item and the
item used is a property of the object.
After assigning the lamp to a circuit (by connecting a line) the information also flows
through the supplying distribution board and the circuit to the symbol.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
395
Introduction
If for example, you edit the name of the distribution board, this will automatically
result in the correction of the symbol label for the objects connected to that board.
The symbol text can be configured as needed and supplemented by additional
information (see 19.4.1, page 488):
Note
For more information on the role and functioning of the product databases and the
relationship between symbol and item, please refer to chapter 0, from page 532.
Index
396
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.1.2 Origin of symbolic representation of objects (plumbing
Object Display
Graphic icon
Icon text:
Hygiene plan type 10 505/805
Calculated power: 236 W
kv lock shield valve: 1.5
kv radiator valve: 0.2
Building model
Basic functions
Pipe network calculation
Radiator calculation
Item
configuration
configuration
extensions,
The object uses an item that it takes from the product database. The items' data
extensions,
record stipulates the symbol to use, its dimensions and the technical parameters of
the radiator. The graphical symbol is therefore a property of the item and the item
used is a property of the object.
The symbol text reflects information that can come from several sources. The
Adjustments,
example shows a combination of item information and calculation results, which were
Adjustments,
made on the basis of the building model. The contents of the symbol text are updated
immediately any time there is a change. The symbol text is configurable. You can
decide what information should be displayed or suppressed (see 19.4.1, page 488).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
397
Introduction
Objects are inserted into the DDS model through a variety of drawing operations.
Each individual object is assigned X, Y and Z position and is visualised by a symbol.
At this point it is necessary to explain this concept in detail. To do this, consider the
DDS model initially as a fixed room in which a movable object is to be placed at a
defined position.
Y
Y‘
X‘
Y
X X
Basic functions
Z
Z‘
Y‘
X‘
Z Y
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The insertion point of the object can only be explained if we considers the object as a
multidimensional structure. This in turn is based on its own object-bound coordinate
system, which also has a zero point and creates the insertion of the object. Thus the
position data X/Y/Z designates the distance between the zero points of the fixed
room -bound coordinate system and that of the movable object-bound coordinate
system.
Index
398
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.1.4 Colour, layer and pen assignment of an object
Layer
A layer is a structure level in DDS-CAD, whose behaviour is configured by the layer
Basic functions
management (see 17.5, page 392). Each object is assigned to exactly one layer and
a group of other objects with common properties. The objects of a layer:
• are visible or invisible on the screen.
• are enabled or locked for editing.
• are shown or disabled in the printout.
• use their own pen or that of the layer.
Pen
The pen determines the colour, line type and line width of the object on the screen
and in the printout. The assignment of the pin to each object can be defined by
configuration
configuration
• the default configuration (lowest priority)
• selection in the individual object (disables default configuration)
• the layer's pen configuration layer (disables all other settings)
Material
The material determines the behaviour of the object in the rendered model (see
extensions,
Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Error! Bookmark not defined.).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
399
Introduction
400
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.2 Working with objects (dynamic symbol)
As long as the cursor is moving the symbol, it is dynamic. If it has been fixed, it
receives its position data as X, Y and Z coordinates, which refer to the global
coordinate system (see 17.1, page 378). In addition, each symbol is given a
rotational angle to the Z axis when you insert it (1):
Y Z
Y Y
Z
X X
Basic functions
X
(1)
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
You have many options to rotate and place the symbol in the model. You can access
the necessary functions via a context menu (click ) or a keyboard shortcut.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
401
Introduction
Working with object-groups is excluded from the descriptions in this chapter, instead
please refer to chapter 18.3 (Page 417).
Calibrating a symbol means inserting it into the model using dimensional data. This
procedure requires the presence of a starting point. DDS-CAD can use both the
current cursor position or the result of the last drawing operation for this purpose. The
two basic types of calibration are summarised in separate submenus.
The following sections provide an overview of each of the possible functions and then
describe the procedure. The subsequent editing of objects is described in chapter 1,
from page 505.
Index
402
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.2.2 Symbol at the cursor
This section describes the options and situations in which the symbol can be inserted
into the model by directly using the mouse and keyboard shortcuts.
(2)
Basic functions
Fix at distance to the line page 405
[D]
[Ctrl]+[D]
configuration
Scale symbol You can change the Help
configuration
[S] symbol size by scal-
ing.
DDS-CAD 7.3
403
Introduction
You use a symbol (e.g. a room stamp) whose position does not have
to be determined precisely. It is only to be fixed at an appropriate
place.
Procedure
Click on the desired position. The symbol has been fixed at the cursor position.
Procedure
Press [Ctrl] and move the cursor closer to the line. The line is
shown in orange and snaps the symbol. You can let it slide along
the line in order to fix it at the desired position.
Click . The symbol is fixed.
Index
404
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
Procedure
Basic functions
Press [Ctrl]+[D]. The symbol is fixed at the set distance.
configuration
configuration
Procedure
DDS-CAD 7.3
405
Introduction
18.2.3.1 Overview
The current position of the cursor is the starting point of the operation. Therefore
first point the first cursor to a reference point. Then call the function:
L
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1
)
Index
406
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.2.3.2 Examples
Basic functions
Calibrate symbol from cursor at right angles with [Shift]+[]/[]/[]/[]
Example
Procedure
configuration
Point to the reference point. The point snaps in the cursor.
configuration
Press [Shift]+[]/[]/[]/[]. The "Move Relative from Cur-
sor Position” dialogue box appears. It is used to input the dis-
tance between the rGeference point and symbol.
Enter the value in metres (m) without a preceding sign. A line shows the position that is
defined by the current input.
extensions,
Procedure
DDS-CAD 7.3
407
Introduction
Procedure
Procedure
408
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
coordinates) dialogue is displayed. It is used to
input the distance and the angle.
Procedure
Move the cursor to the position from where the perpendicular is to fall on the vanishing
line.
Basic functions
Press [Shift]+[L]. The symbol is temporarily fixed at the old cursor position and a mov-
able line leads from the symbol to the cursor. The message line shows the "Wählen Sie
die Fluchtlinie" (Select the vanishing line) prompt.
Point to the desired vanishing line. The line is highlighted orange. From the symbol the
perpendicular will fall on the vanishing line. The intersection point indicates the position of
the symbol:
Click . The symbol has been fixed at the position indicated.
Move symbol at right angles to the centre point with [Shift]+[C] configuration
configuration
Example
extensions,
extensions,
Procedure
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
409
Introduction
Procedure
Click on the second point of the comparison section. The symbol has been shifted so
that distance and direction correspond to the comparison section.
Rotate and Place Centered between This and Next Point [Shift]+[S]
Example
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Procedure
410
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
Procedure
Procedure
Basic functions
Click on the second reference point. The symbol has been inserted centred between
two points. It has retained its original rotation.
When using the "Move Relative from Last Position” method, the current position of
the cursor is irrelevant. The coordinate input refers either to the zero point of the
configuration
global coordinate system or to a local coordinate system (see 17.1, page 378). In the
configuration
latter case, two different scenarios are possible:
1
2 5
4
3
extensions,
extensions,
following operation.
DDS-CAD 7.3
411
Introduction
coordinates a
[9] A X‘
412
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.2.4.3 Examples
Procedure
Click OK or press [Enter]. The new symbol is fixed at the entered distance to the
reference symbol.
Basic functions
Note
You can form chains of individual objects through a consecutive execution of this operation.
The last distance input is saved and is applied as a suggestion for the next operation
configuration
configuration
Procedure
extensions,
Move the cursor to the intersection point between circle and wall line. The intersection
point captures the cursor and holds it tight.
Click . The symbol has been fixed at the position of the intersection point.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
413
Introduction
Procedure
Example
Procedure
414
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.2.5 Adjust installation height
Basic functions
coordinate system (see 17.1,
page 378).
Y
Z DZ
You can set the mounting height either as the difference (DZ) to the current working
height or as an absolute value (Z). If you input a difference the new mounting height
configuration
is calculated. The result can be positive or negative. If you input an absolute value
configuration
you specify the new mounting height directly as a positive or negative value.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
415
Introduction
You are working with a symbol at the current working height of 2m. You want to change the
mounting height up or down by a difference to the current working height. The example shows
a change of 0.5m downwards.
Procedure
Press [PgDn] for downwards movement. The "Relative from Last Position) dialogue
box is displayed.
Enter the value for the height change without preceding + or - sign in metres (m) and
click OK . The working height has been recalculated by the program. The status bar at
the bottom of the screen shows the result of the operation and you can continue working.
Basic functions
You are working with a symbol at the current working height of 2.23m. You want to adjust the
mounting height to 1.5m.
Procedure
Press [Home] for the new mounting height. The "Mounting height“ dialogue box is dis-
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
played.
Enter the desired mounting height. The value can be positive or negative.
Click OK . The working height has been changed to the specified value. The status
bar at the bottom of the screen shows the result of the operation and you can continue
working.
Index
416
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
We have to differentiate between the group (1) and the individual object (2). The
object group defines the arrangement of each object, i.e. the number and spacing.
Basic functions
the same group and/or all of its
(1) properties (such as item, mounting
height, colour, etc.) can be edited
(2) separately too.
The starting point is the current object that is located at the cursor as a dynamic
symbol. To call the object group, proceed as follows:
configuration
You want to use an object (e.g. a lamp) in an object-group.
configuration
Procedure
Start the desired function (e.g. fluorescent lamps). The product database is dis-
played and allows you to select an item.
Select the desired item and click OK . You are taken to the component's object
extensions,
Set the properties of the object (e.g. mounting height and attributes) and click
OK . The symbol of the object is located at the cursor.
Click . The context menu is displayed and offers two options for forming an ob-
ject group:
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
417
Introduction
The group's
Quantity in the X
i
coordinate
Quantity in the X Quantity in the Y system does
i i not have to
Quantity in the Y match the
i
global
coordinate
system of the
whole model. It
dX can be rotated
or tilted
dY X
dX compared to the
Y X model.
dY Y
In this situation,
the respective X- and Y-parameters appear to be exchanged with each other and
must handled as such in the "Objekt-Gruppe (Feld)" (Object group (box)) dialogue.
Index
418
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
The "Object group" dialogue is where you specify the ratio between the parameter
pairs. Depending on the usage option (see 18.3.2.5 to 18.3.2.9) it appears at the start
or completion of the drawing operation. The dialogue comes in two variants, which
differ in the "Start point” (1) and "Distance” (2) parameters. The variant is
automatically determined by the object used and the significance of the parameters is
shown by an image (3) in the dialogue.
(3)
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
For most object types, the "Start point” (1) and "Distance” (2) parameters relate to the
mounting points of the objects (left picture). The dimensions (e.g. of strip lights) must
therefore be taken into account when entering the distances. When using PV
modules the "Start point” (1) and "Distance” (2) parameters relate to the physical
boundaries of the object and thus allow the dimensions to be arranged in sequence.
configuration
configuration
The other controls are the same for both types of dialogue box. Different
combinations of options for orientation and placement adjust the object group to the
respective usage context. They are predefined by the usage variant and can be
corrected later.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
419
Introduction
There are three usage variants for using the object group (box). The selected variant
determines whether the size of the area is fixed or variable.
Select surface
The "Select surface” usage variant is connected to defined rooms or roof areas of the
building model as per chapter 5. It distributes the objects to the room or the roof area.
The cut of this are can be polygonal. It is invariable in size and contour and specified
by the room. The room boundary defines the limits of the object group. Position and
distances of the objects are variable.
example.
Define surface
The "Define surface” usage variant is not bound by any conditions. It distributes the
objects symmetrically over a defined area. Position and distances of the objects are
variable. The difference to "Select surface” is that the contour is only formed in the
course of the operation. You can choose a polygonal area (left) by precisely
specifying the sub-sections or a rectangle (right) by defining the diagonal:
Dynamic insert
The "Dynamic insert” usage variant is not bound by any conditions. It defines an
object group as a dynamic symbol. You enter the number of objects, and all
distances. The area expansion is a result of the operation.
420
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.3.2.4 Notes on the settings
(2)
Basic functions
Orientation Meaning and application
Number The typical application is the "Dynamic insert” usage variant.
and All parameters are free to enter. The area (a) is the result of a calculation.
distance It is determined by the number of objects, their distances from each other
and to the starting point. There is no difference between free and centred
arrangement.
Number The number of objects is free to enter. The distances between the objects
are calculated. The objects are distributed evenly across the available area
in the desired quantity.
Typical applications include the "Select surface” and "Define surface”
usage variants.
configuration
Free arrangement Centred arrangement
configuration
The starting point is free to The position of the starting point is
enter. Thus, the object group calculated so that the object group is
can be positioned within the centred on the area. In this way, the
area as desired. distances between the objects are
twice as large as from the external
object to the edge of the area.
extensions,
Distance The distances between the objects is free to enter. The potential number of
extensions,
enter. Thus, the object group calculated so that the object group is
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
421
Introduction
Application
Select the desired object (e.g. lamp), set its properties and start the usage vari-
ant. The cursor moves an object group as a dynamic symbol. The settings and
distances correspond to the last application.
Basic functions
Move the cursor to the desired area. The area snaps the object group and the
group is adjusted to the contours of the area. Unnecessary objects are removed
from the group.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click . The group is fixed and the "Comp. group” dialogue box is displayed.
Adjust the settings of the object group.
Click OK . The cursor again moves an object group as a dynamic symbol. You
can continue to work or end the function with [ESC].
Index
422
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.3.2.6 Example for the "Select surface” usage variant (PV modules on the
Application
Select the desired PV module, set its properties and start the usage variant. The
cursor moves an object group as a dynamic symbol. The settings and distances
correspond to the last application.
Basic functions
Move the cursor to the desired roof area. The area is highlighted by a wide green
line. The object group adjusts to the contours of the area.
configuration
Click . The group is fixed. The "Object group (area)" dialogue box is displayed.
configuration
extensions,
(1)
extensions,
Check "Place max” (1). The roof area is filled with the maximum possible
number of PV modules of the selected size.
Click OK . The cursor again moves an object group as a dynamic symbol. You
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
423
Introduction
Application
Select the desired object (e.g. lamp), set its properties and start the usage vari-
ant. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the following
prompt: "Select first point in contour....
Define the diagonal of the desired rectangle by clicking :
Basic functions
2
1
Press [Enter]. The area is covered with a number of objects and the "Object-
Group (Area)” dialogue box is displayed. The settings and distances correspond
to the last application.
Adjust the settings of the object group.
Click OK . The object group in the model is displayed according to the new
settings and the dialogue closes. The function remains active and the message
line returns to the prompt: "Select first point in contour.... You can define another
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
424
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.3.2.8 Example for the "Define surface” usage variant (Polygon)
Application
Select the desired object (e.g. lamp), set its properties and start the usage vari-
ant. The cursor turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the following
prompt: "Select first point in contour....
Define the first corner of the desired area by clicking . The cursor moves a dy-
namic line.
Draw the area counter-clockwise (to make the use of auxiliary functions possi-
ble).
Basic functions
Close the contour. To do this, use the auxiliary functions from the context menu
(see 19.1.7, page 457).
The area is covered with a number of objects
and the "Object-Group (Area)” dialogue box
is displayed. The settings and distances cor-
respond to the last application.
configuration
configuration
Adjust the settings of the object group.
Click OK . The object group in the model is displayed according to the new
settings and the dialogue closes. The function remains active and the message
line returns to the prompt: "Select first point in contour.... You can define another
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
425
Introduction
Application
Select the desired object (e.g. lamp), set its properties and start the usage vari-
ant. The "Object group (box)" dialogue box is displayed.
Adjust the settings of the object group and click OK . The object group is dis-
played at the cursor as a dynamic symbol. You can fix it in the drawing as often
as required. [ESC] ends the function.
The three parameters number, starting point X and distance dX control the group.
The starting point determines the distance between the origin of the coordinate
system and the first object of the group. The distances between the objects are each
the same size.
426
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
18.3.3.2 "Define Line” usage variant
Application
Select the desired object, set its properties in the object dialogue and confirm
with OK . The object is displayed at the cursor as a dynamic symbol.
If necessary, adjust the desired rotation for the symbol (see 18.2.2, page 403).
Note
This step is necessary if the current position of the symbol at the cursor does
not match the planned location in the model:
Basic functions
Select 'Set line "Define Line” usage variant from the context menu. The cursor
turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the following prompt: "Select first
point of line”.
Click on the position where the line is to begin. The cursor moves the movable
end of a line. The message line shows the "Select second point of line” prompt.
configuration
Click on the position where the line is to end. The objects are arranged along
configuration
the defined section and the "Object-Group (Line)” dialogue box is displayed. The
settings (starting point and distance) correspond to the last application.
Correct the settings as required and click OK . The function remains active.
You can define another line or end the function with [ESC].
extensions,
extensions,
1
settings in the "Object-Group (Line)” dialogue box.
Adjustments,
X dX
Application
Select the desired object, set its properties in the object dialogue and confirm
with OK . The object is displayed at the cursor as a dynamic symbol.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
427
Introduction
Adjust the settings of the object group and click OK . The object group is dis-
played at the cursor as a dynamic symbol. You can fix it in the drawing as often
as required. [ESC] ends the function.
As was mentioned in the previous section, the behaviour of the line length (a) –
whether fixed or variable – is specified by the usage variants.
(2)
Number The number of objects is free to enter. The distances between the objects
Index
428
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Objects – Building blocks of the model Erro
r!
are calculated. The objects are distributed evenly across the available line
in the desired quantity.
Basic functions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
429
Introduction
When editing an object group, you have to distinguish between the objects within the
group and the group as an independent object.
All operations for deleting, moving or editing properties can be applied to the objects
within the group (see 1, page 505).
Warning!
With the exception of the Undo function, a deleted object cannot be re-inserted
into the group. As such, you should only delete individual objects if all other
adjustments have already been completed.
For editing individual objects carry out the selection with the options described in
20.1, page 505. If on the other hand, you want to edit ALL objects in a group there is
a simplified procedure for selecting them:
Select an object from the group. The selected object is shown
Basic functions
If you want to edit the group as an independent object, you first need to select it in
the following way:
Select an object from the group.
The selected object is shown dark, all others are displayed
light blue.
Click . The context menu is displayed.
Select the "Select Group” function. All objects are displayed in
dark blue.
Perform the editing operation (see 1, page 505).
Index
430
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19 Drawing and labelling
Basic functions
three-dimensional shape, DDS-CAD asks for the height.
configuration
you edit a value
configuration
numerically in the
object dialogue or
Move circle Adjust radius
dynamically with
the mouse. extensions,
extensions,
Auxiliary geometries are used to support a drawing operation. With them you can, for
example, form helper line and intersection points, which will assist you in the
arrangement of other objects. Auxiliary geometries are only displayed on the screen
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
431
Introduction
Nodes
Basic functions
Segment
A segment is defined as the connections between the nodes. The centre point of a
segment is used as the reference for subsequent editing. When a polyline is
selected, it is displayed as an open square . Using the segment, new nodes can
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
be inserted in the polyline. A segment can be shifted in parallel, and deleted in the
case of a polyline. The polyline is disconnected.
432
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.2 Overview of the functions
Basic functions
passes through the nodes
which are support points for
Spline an interpolation. The nodes
are thus connected with
each other by curves.
configuration
configuration
19.1.2.3 Rounded polyline
Rounded polyline
DDS-CAD 7.3
433
Introduction
19.1.2.5 Polygon/crosshatch
19.1.2.6 3D polygon
3D polygon
Index
434
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.2.7 Revision cloud
Revision cloud
Basic functions
After calling the function, DDS-CAD expects the starting point
(1) . It is the first node at the start of the polyline, only after
subsequent operations (1) is a visible result created in the
model.
configuration
configuration
In the cursor position Define freely Segment 19.1.3.2,
You can determine the page 436
start point of the poly-
line by clicking . The
position of the start
point and cursor
Define on existing
extensions,
match
point
extensions,
existing polyline.
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
435
Introduction
Define freely
Example
Procedure
Move the cursor to the desired position and click . The cursor moves a dynamic line.
You can execute the next operation.
corner).
Procedure
436
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.3.3 Continuing existing polylines
Procedure
Basic functions
19.1.3.4 Constructing the starting point
configuration
configuration
Procedure
Enter the length of the point shift in metres (m) without preceding + or - sign and click
extensions,
OK . The position of the starting point has been defined at the specified position.
The cursor moves a dynamic line. You can execute the next operation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
437
Introduction
Construct starting point: Shifted in the X- and Y-direction from the cursor
Example
The distances from the reference point to the starting point are known
-DX as DX and DY. In this way an indirect construction is possible using rela-
-Dy tive coordinates.
Procedure
Enter the values for each direction in metres (m). Note the effect of the preceding + or -
Basic functions
sign. A line shows the reference point at the position of the starting point while main-
taining the current settings. Each additional change is immediately visible on the screen,
so that you can correct the input.
Click OK . The position of the starting point has been defined at the specified posi-
tion. The cursor moves a dynamic line. You can execute the next operation.
Construct starting point: Shifted with length and direction from the cursor
Example
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The distances from the reference point to the starting point are known
a as length (L) and angle a (orientation). In this way an indirect construc-
L tion is possible using polar coordinates.
Procedure
Enter the values. Observe the effect of the preceding + or - sign. A line shows the refer-
ence point at the position of the starting point while maintaining the current settings.
Each additional change is immediately visible on the screen.
Click OK . The position of the starting point has been defined at the specified posi-
tion. The cursor moves a dynamic line. You can execute the next operation.
Index
438
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Basic functions
Double/halve ortho angle
configuration
configuration
Snap point with
[Shift] (1)
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
439
Introduction
Basic functions
Double Ortho angle Press [*] on the numeric keypad. The Ortho angle
[*] (numeric keypad) has been doubled.
Halve Ortho angle Press [/] on the numeric keypad. The Ortho angle
[/] (numeric keypad) has been halved.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
440
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.4.3 Snap functions
You are drawing a polyline (1) and want to fix a new node directly on
(1) an existing line (2). The angle at which both lines meet each other can
be entered freely and ≠90°.
(2)
Procedure
Press [Ctrl] and move the cursor to the existing line (2). [Ctrl]
(1) enables snap lines. The existing line (2) is highlighted in orange and
snaps in the cursor with the dynamic line. You can slide the cursor
(2)
along the marked line.
Click . The node has been fixed at the position indicated. It is located precisely on the
existing line.
Snap line at right angles with "Use Snap Points” option enabled
Basic functions
Example
You are drawing a polyline (1) and want to fix a new node on an exist-
(1) ing line (2) so that both are at right angles to each other.
(2)
Procedure
Enable the "Use Snap Points” option and move the cursor to the
existing line (2). DDS-CAD automatically calculates the correct
configuration
position of the intersection point. The calculated intersection point
configuration
captures the cursor and holds it tight. The position is shown.
Click . The node has been fixed at the position indicated.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
441
Introduction
You are drawing a polyline (1). The "Use Snap Points” option (see
(1) 17.3.4, page 387) is not active and for technical reasons should not be
switched on permanently. Nevertheless, you want to fix a new node
directly to an existing point (e.g. a room corner). Snap points should be
activated temporarily
Procedure
Press [Shift] and move the cursor to the reference point. [Shift]
(1) enables snap points. The intended point is marked by an orange
circle (2). It captures the cursor with the dynamic line and snaps it
(2)
in.
Click . The node has been fixed at the position of the reference point.
Procedure
Press [Backspace].
Each key press releases the current node .
Index
442
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.5 Construct polyline horizontally
Basic functions
The starting point is the Diagonally in the X and
Y directions with [8] DX 8
current node , the
-Dy
position of the cursor
plays no role.
configuration
Indirect construction is cally/horizontally from 19.1.5.3,
configuration
necessary if the section the cursor with ? page 446
from the current node [Shift]+[]
to the new node is
not determined numeri-
cally. The position of Shifted in the X- and Y-
the new node is de- direction from the cur- -DX
fined indirectly by sor with ? -Dy
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
443
Introduction
Procedure
Click OK . The segment has been drawn in the specified direction. You can execute
the next operation.
Basic functions
The distances from the operation's starting point to the new node
DX 8 are known as DX and DY. In this way, a direct construction is possible
-Dy using relative coordinates, where the preceding + or - signs define the
direction.
Procedure
444
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
a The distances from the operation's starting point to the new node
9 are known as length (L) and angle a (orientation). In this way an direct
-a
L construction is possible using polar coordinates.
Procedure
Basic functions
Click OK . The segment has been drawn in the specified direction. You can execute
the next operation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
445
Introduction
Procedure
Procedure
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Enter the values. Note the effect of the preceding + or - sign. A line points from the refer-
ence point to the position of the new node . Each change is immediately visible, so
that you can correct the input.
Click OK . The new node has been fixed. A new segment connects it to the previ-
ously current node . You can execute the next operation.
Index
446
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Procedure
Enter the values. Note the effect of the preceding + or - sign. A line points from the refer-
ence point to the position of the new node . Each change is immediately visible, so
Basic functions
that you can correct the input.
Click OK . The new node has been fixed. A new segment connects it to the previ-
ously current node . You can execute the next operation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
447
Introduction
For the following descriptions, the three-dimensional coordinate system is used for
the visualisation. We therefore switch from the plan view (left) to the 3D view (right):
Y Z
(1)
(1) Y
X
(2) (2) X
The two-dimensional plane between X- and Y-axis (1) is used as the reference plane.
It corresponds to the height 0m. The viewpoint of the observer (2) is located in the
3rd quadrant slightly above the reference plane in all examples. Its view is directed
Basic functions
towards the 2nd quadrant between the now vertical Z axis and the horizontal Y-axis.
Z Z
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Z (+DZ (-DZ)
Y Y
Z
X X
As a result of the operation the polyline runs on a different working height (Z), which
is displayed in the status bar at the bottom of the screen:
The resulting working height (Z) is an absolute value, which may be either positive or
negative. The example shows a vertical downward movement (negative DZ), whose
target is below the reference plane (see 17.3.2, page 385). This leads to a
corresponding message in the status bar.
Index
448
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
X
Z
The change in working height is often necessary, for example when applying pipeline
functions. Typical examples are pipes, ventilation ducts, cable installation systems,
lightning conductors, etc. The same principles apply in all cases.
One important way is working with height or height difference and the gradient angle.
Examples for the application can be found in the following sections: 19.1.6.4 and
19.1.6.5. At this point, basic instructions are given.
The function is called for the direct construction by [PgUp]/ [PgDn]. For indirect
construction use [Shift]+[PgUp]/ [PgDn]. In both cases, the "Collect Points”
Basic functions
dialogue box is displayed. When entering the different values DDS-CAD
automatically considers the inevitable geometric dependencies of these values to
each other. Changing a value automatically calls a recalculation of all other values.
configuration
configuration
Indirect construction will be used as an example. In this case, X- and Y-coordinates
are already fixed, as they are defined by the cursor position. Therefore, a single value
is sufficient to determine the new Z-coordinate. This can either be the desired height
difference (DZ), the absolute Z-position or the required gradient angle.
X
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
449
Introduction
different values:
D Input ”Angle (draw dir.)” (a) is the
a Z
deviation from the original drawing
Z Y
b direction.
Input "Angle (coordinate plane)" (b) is
forrás nem
található., pa-
ge Error!
Bookmark not
defined.
Polar Z
coordinates a
[9] Y
450
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
cally. The position of
the new node is de- Relative Z
a X
Basic functions
new node are calculated by the pro-
gram. For the jump from the current to
D the new node the target height (Z) or
Z Y
a the height difference (DZ) and the angle
for the rise (a) are known.
Procedure
configuration
Press [PgUp] for an upwards movement and/or [PgDn] for a downwards movement.
configuration
The "Collect Points” dialogue box appears. This is used to separately input the point shift
in the X, Y and Z directions.
(1)
(2)
(3)
extensions,
extensions,
Enter the values for the height jump. If the difference to the current working height is
known, select Input "Up" / "Down" (1) for the input. If you know the desired target height,
select "Absolute Z position" (2) in Input . The other value is automatically recalculated.
Adjustments,
Enter the angle for the rise in Input ”Angle (draw dir.)” (Angle (draw direction)) (3).
Adjustments,
Click OK . The segment has been continued horizontally in the current draw direction.
The rise starts from the previously current node to the new working height in the de-
fined angle. The position of the new node has been calculated. The status bar (at the bot-
tom of the screen) shows the current working height. Carry out the next operation.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
451
Introduction
current node is crucial. For more information on the "Collect Points” dialogue box, please refer
to 19.1.6.2, page 449.
Procedure
Press [8]. The "by relative or polar coordinates` dialogue is displayed. This is used to
Basic functions
Enter the values for each direction in metres (m). Note the effect of the preceding + or -
sign. The segment is displayed in the drawing and shows the effect of the current set-
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
tings. Each additional change is immediately visible on the screen, so that you can cor-
rect the input.
Click OK . The segment has been drawn in the specified direction.
The status bar (at the bottom of the screen) shows the current working height. Carry out
the next operation.
Index
452
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Procedure
Press [9]. The "by relative or polar coordinates` dialogue is displayed. It is used to in-
put the distance (length of the segment), the angle (orientation of the segment) and the
height.
Basic functions
Enter the values and observe the effect of the preceding + or - sign. You can define the
height as the difference to the current height ( Input "Relative Z-height") or you can de-
configuration
fine a target height ( Input "Absolute mounting height"). The other value is recalculated.
configuration
The segment is displayed in the drawing and shows the effect of the current settings.
Each additional change is immediately visible on the screen, so that you can correct the
input.
Click OK . The segment has been drawn in the specified direction.
The status bar (at the bottom of the screen) shows the current working height. Execute
the next operation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
453
Introduction
Procedure
Move the cursor to the reference point. The point snaps in the cursor.
Press [Shift]+[PgUp] for an upwards movement or [Shift]+[PgDn] for a downwards
Basic functions
movement. The "Collect Points” dialogue box appears. This is used to separately input
the point shift in the X, Y and Z directions.
(1)
(2)
(3)
Enter the values. All other values depend on these and are calculated automatically.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click OK . The segment has been continued horizontally in the current draw direction.
The rise starts from the previously current node to the new working height in the de-
fined angle. The position of the new node has been calculated. The status bar (at the bot-
tom of the screen) shows the current working height. Carry out the next operation.
When working with height and gradient angle, the draw direction of the last segment to the
current node is crucial. For more information on the "Collect Points” dialogue box, please re-
fer to 19.1.6.2, page 449.
Index
454
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Indirect construction of a change in height with relative coordinates
Procedure
Move the cursor to the reference point. The point snaps in the cursor.
Press [Shift]+[8]. The "by relative or polar coordinates` dialogue is displayed. This is
used to separately input the point shift in the X, Y and Z directions.
Basic functions
Enter the values for each direction in metres (m). Observe the effect of the preceding + or
- sign. A line points from the reference point to the position of the new node while
maintaining the current settings. Each additional change is immediately visible on the
screen, so that you can correct the input.
Click OK .
configuration
The position of the new node has been fixed and a new segment connects it to the
configuration
previously current node. The status bar (at the bottom of the screen) shows the current
working height. Execute the next operation.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
455
Introduction
Procedure
Move the cursor to the reference point. The point snaps in the cursor.
Press [Shift]+[9]. The "by relative or polar coordinates` dialogue is displayed. It is used to
input the distance (length of the segment), the angle (orientation of the segment) and the
height.
Basic functions
Enter the values and observe the effect of the preceding + or - sign. You can define the
height as the difference to the current height ( Input "Relative Z-height") or you can define
a target height ( Input "Absolute mounting height"). The other value is recalculated. A line
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
points from the reference point to the position of the new node while maintaining the
current settings. Each additional change is immediately visible on the screen, so that you
can correct the input.
Click OK . The segment has been drawn in the specified direction.
The status bar (at the bottom of the screen) shows the current working height. Execute the
next operation.
Index
456
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.7 End polyline, close contour
Basic functions
Overview: End function, close contour
Function/shortcut Polyline result Polygon result
Ready The polyline ends at the current node . The function remains
active and you can start the next polyline.
[Enter]
configuration
configuration
Start Start
End at cursor position The polyline ends at the position of the cursor . The function
remains active and you can start the next polyline.
extensions,
[Shift]+[Enter]
extensions,
Start Start
Adjustments,
starting node . The function remains active and you can start
[H] the next polyline.
Start Start
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
457
Introduction
Close region with 90° an- The polyline is closed. A new node is constructed so that
gle there is a right angle between the last two segments. The func-
tion remains active and you can start the next polyline.
[E]
Start Start
Close region with two 90° The polyline is closed. A new node is constructed, so that
angles the segments between the current node and the start node
form two right angles. The function remains active and you can
start the next polyline.
Start Start
Basic functions
Close region at right angle The polyline is closed and a new node is constructed. Here,
to first line. the last segment is extended so that the new node is located
perpendicular above the starting point. The function remains
[V] active and you can start the next polyline.
Start Start
ended.
[ESC]
Start Start
Index
458
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.1.8 Edit polyline
Move the cursor onto it, then the symbol turns green.
You receive a message about dynamic editing function
that you call by clicking .
We shall introduce the functions and contrast the starting position and the result of
the operation.
Basic functions
19.1.8.1 Dynamic editing functions
Edit node
Function Example Procedure
configuration
concluded.
configuration
Insert Click on the centre point of the segment
node and release the mouse button. The segment
has been divided at its centre point. The cur-
sor moves the new node.
Click on the desired position. The node
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
459
Introduction
Edit node
Function Example Explanation, procedure
460
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Delete line (1) After calling the function, the selected segment
segment is removed. There are two independent objects
(1) and (2).
(2)
Shift line After calling the function, the cursor moves the
segment in selected segment and enables a parallel shift.
parallel
Basic functions
Shift polyline After calling the function, the cursor moves the
in parallel entire polyline and enables a parallel shift.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
461
Introduction
In the dynamic method you generate the shape by a series of mouse clicks . For
example, after calling the function a circle requires two clicks : The first determines
the centre of the circle, the second determines the radius. In case of a three-
Basic functions
(1
(2
You can then handle the object like a symbol. You can copy it, move it or edit its
properties. Depending on the type of the object or the parameters, you edit a value
numerically in the object dialogue or dynamically with the mouse:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
462
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.2.1 Circle
Circle
Basic functions
Application
Adjust radius
configuration
configuration
(1
(2 Move circle
symbolises the radius and the circle is visible. Its size is determined by the cur-
extensions,
sor.
Fix the shape by clicking (2). The shape is prepared. The function remains
active.
Adjustments,
If you have selected a circle, you can dynamically change the position and the radius
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
463
Introduction
(3)
(1
Basic functions
(2)
Application
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(3
(1
(2
Stretch angle
Stretch radius
Move arc
464
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
If you have selected an arc, you can dynamically change the position and the radius
of the shape as well as the positions of the transition and end point. To do this, click
19.2.3 Cylinder
The function creates a cylinder. The geometry of the shape results
from the radius of the circle and the height. You define the centre
point of the circle and its radius by clicking . The height is queried
during the operation.
Cylinder
Adjust radius
(1
extensions,
(2
extensions,
Move cylinder
sor.
Adjustments,
If you have selected a cylinder, you can dynamically change the position and the
radius of the shape. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
465
Introduction
Cone You define the centre point of the two circles and their radii by
clicking . The height is queried during the operation.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Application
(1
(2 (3
Adjust radius
Move cone
466
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Fix the shape by clicking (3). The shape is prepared. The function remains
active.
19.2.5 Rectangle
The function creates a rectangle by defining the starting point (1)
and end point (2) of the diagonals (in each case by clicking ).
DDS-CAD transfers the length and width dimensions to the shape's
object dialogue.
Rectangle
Basic functions
(1
(2)
Application
extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
(1
(2
Adjustments,
Shift seg-
Adjustments,
ment
Move corner
Move rectangle
DDS-CAD 7.3
467
Introduction
If you have selected a rectangle, you can dynamically change the position of the
entire shape. You change the size by moving the vertices and line segments. To do
this, click on the handle on the object.
19.2.6 Cuboid
The function creates a cuboid. You define the diagonal of a
rectangle (as base), the height is requested during the operation.
Cuboid
Basic functions
(1
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(2)
Application
(1
(2
Shift seg-
ment
Move corner
Move rectangle
Index
468
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Select the "Cuboid" function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
If you have selected a cuboid, you can dynamically change the position of the entire
shape. You change the size by moving the vertices and line segments. To do this,
click on the handle on the object.
Basic functions
You define the centre point of the circle and its radius by clicking .
You correct the number of sides by subsequent editing of the
Regular object.
polygon
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
469
Introduction
(1 (2
Adjust radius
Move polygon
If you have selected a regular polygon, you can dynamically change the position and
the radius of the shape. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
Basic functions
19.2.8 Pyramid
The function creates an equilateral pyramid with polygonal base.
The vertices are at equal distances on a circle. The geometry of the
shape results from the radius of the circle, the number of sides and
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
the height.
You define the centre point of the circle and its radius by clicking .
Pyramid The height is queried during the operation. You can correct the
number of sides by subsequently editing the object.
Index
470
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
(1 (2
Adjust radius
Basic functions
Move pyramid
configuration
Enter the height and click OK . The shape is prepared. The function remains
configuration
active.
If you have selected a pyramid, you can dynamically change the position and the
radius of the shape. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
extensions,
extensions,
19.2.9 Prism
The function creates an equilateral prism with polygonal base. The
vertices are at equal distances on a circle. The geometry of the
Adjustments,
shape results from the radius of the circle, the number of sides and
Adjustments,
the height.
You define the centre point of the circle and its radius by clicking .
Prism The height is queried during the operation. You can correct the
number of sides by subsequently editing the object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
471
Introduction
Application
Basic functions
(1 (2
Adjust radius
Move prism
If you have selected a prism, you can dynamically change the position and the radius
of the shape. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
Index
472
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.2.10 Truncated pyramid (polyhedron)
You define the centre point of the two circles and their radii by
Polyhedron clicking . The height is queried during the operation. You can
correct the number of sides by subsequently editing the object.
Basic functions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
473
Introduction
(1 (2 (3
Adjust radius
Move polyhedron
tive.
If you have selected a truncated pyramid, you can dynamically change the position of
the shape as well as the radii of the base and top surface. To do this, click on the
handle on the object.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
474
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.2.11 Ball
Ball
Basic functions
Application
configuration
configuration
(1
(2
Adjust radius
extensions,
extensions,
Move sphere
Fix the radius by clicking (2). The shape is prepared. The function remains
active.
If you have selected a sphere, you can dynamically change the position and the
radius of the shape. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
475
Introduction
Ellipse
Basic functions
Application
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1 (2
(3
Stretch ellipse
Move ellipse
If you have selected an ellipse, you can dynamically change the position of the shape
as well as the radii. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
Index
476
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Elliptic arc
Basic functions
Application
(1 (2 configuration
configuration
(3
extensions,
Stretch ellipse
extensions,
(4
Move ellipse
(5
Select the "Elliptical arc" function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Click on the position of the centre point (1). The cursor moves a line, which
symbolises the diameter of the first circle.
Fix the radius 1 by clicking (2). The first circle is visible. The movement of the
cursor dynamically determines the radius of the second (hidden) circle. The el-
lipse resulting from the cursor position is visible.
Fix the radius by clicking (3). The cursor moves a dynamic line (4). This speci-
fies the starting point (starting angle) of the arc.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
477
Introduction
Fix the endpoint of the arc by clicking (5). The shape is prepared. The function
remains active.
If you have selected an elliptical arc, you can dynamically change the position of the
shape as well as the radii. To do this, click on the handle on the object.
19.2.14 Network
The function creates a network of horizontal and vertical lines. You
can enter the dimensions of the object (1) and the distances
between the lines (2) as parameters. The network is used as a
dynamic symbol. Use this function for labelling and assistance
when designing.
Net-
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1)
(2)
Index
478
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.3 Working with auxiliary geometries
configuration
try, press [Esc].
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
479
Introduction
Select the point (vertex, intersection, endpoint). Press and hold [Shift] and move
the cursor to the point. If the cursor gets close to the point, the cursor is snapped
in. The point is indicated by an orange circle:
Click . A menu is displayed with all the help geometry functions that are useful
for an active point (see 19.3.1.1, page 479) as above, when accessing from tool-
box).
Select the function required from the menu. The function is executed and then
ended.
Basic functions
480
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.3.1.4 Help geometry – lines
Horizontal help line [Shift]+[H] The function places a horizontal auxiliary line
through the cursor position.
Line through the [Shift]+[1] The function places a helper line through the
cursor position at the cursor position and asks for the inclination angle.
angle?
Basic functions
Line through the [Shift]+[3] The function places a helper line from the cursor to
cursor position to the the selected circle. Select the circle by clicking .
circle
Line between cursor [Shift]+[2] The function places a helper line through the
position + next point cursor position and another point. Select the point
configuration
by clicking .
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index configuration
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
481
Introduction
Circle through cursor [Shift]+[5] The function draws a circle through the cursor
position + next point position and one other point. Determine the point
with r=? by clicking . The radius of the circle is then
queried.
Circle through cursor [Shift]+[4] The function draws a circle around the cursor
Basic functions
position with radius position. You can enter the radius or define by
query/ dyn. radius clicking .
Circle with r=? At [Shift]+[3] The function place a circle tangent to the selected
limiting geometry geometric shapes, e.g. between intersecting lines.
The radius is queried. Thereafter, the lines have to
be determined by clicking . Finally, you also
define the position by clicking (In this example
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
482
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Basic functions
Select the function required from the menu. The function is executed and then
ended.
19.3.2.2 Overview
configuration
arc as circle without prompting.
configuration
Line through circle [Ctrl]+[1] After calling the function the cursor moves a
centre point dynamic line. It begins in the centre point of the
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
483
Introduction
Parallel circle with [Ctrl]+[3] The function creates a circle that is concentric to the
dynamic radius active circle. You can define the radius by clicking
or enter it numerically.
Tangent to the next [Ctrl]+[6] The function places a line tangent from the active
selected circle circle to the next selected circle. Select the second
circle by clicking .
19.3.3.1 Call
Select the line. To do this press [Ctrl] and move the cursor to the line. If the
cursor gets close to the line, this is highlighted orange:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the function required from the menu. The function is executed and then
ended.
Index
484
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.3.3.2 Overview
Repeat last geometry [Ctrl]+[7] The last operation is applied to the active line
again.
Basic functions
Dynamic parallel line [Ctrl]+[3] The function places a parallel to the active
line. The position needs to be determined by
clicking .
Parallel help lines The function creates parallel helper lines with
equal distances between the active line and
the next point.
configuration
After calling the function the cursor moves a
configuration
dynamic line. Define the next point by clicking
. The distance between the lines is queried.
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
485
Introduction
486
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Basic functions
help geometry. If the cursor gets close to the geometry, this is highlighted or-
ange:
configuration
Click . A menu is displayed with the available functions
configuration
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
487
Introduction
(1)
(2) (4)
Basic functions
(5)
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
All variables are displayed with the label "x" (3) in the symbol text. Their final
appearance can be complemented by pre-text and attachment, and be adjusted
further (for more information please refer to 19.4.1.3, page 491). The entire text can
be framed (4) and given a reference line (5) to the object. The information and values
displayed originate from the object or the item used.
Index
488
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.4.1.2 Propose symbol texts
Basic functions
in the model. You may need to adjust
the position (see 19.4.4, page 498).
configuration
text symbol and thereby determine the position of the text directly. The description
configuration
uses the example of a washbasin. It is assumed that all washbasins in the model
should be labelled with a symbol text:
Select an object of the component group (in this case any washbasin).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
489
Introduction
Symbol text
washbasins.
Index
490
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.4.1.3 Setting the text properties (font, font size, colour)
(3)
Basic functions
(2) (1)
By default, the function is not active. Therefore a configuration (2) of the text
configuration
properties (3) applies to all objects of the same component group. For example, all
configuration
washbasins are affected by the change, but toilets or showers are not.
If "Allow properties per text” (1) is active, you can change the text properties for
each individual object in the respective component group. Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
491
Introduction
At the beginning of this chapter, we mentioned that you can create, adjust and save
additional text configurations for every type of object, pipeline or room. This operation
consists of three steps:
1. Create text configuration
2. Select and arrange blocks for display
3. Configure block
(2)
(1)
(3)
(4)
Basic functions
(5)
(6)
(7)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
492
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
2. Select and arrange blocks for display
The order of the variables in the table determines the arrangement of the text blocks
in the symbol text. To correct the position of the text block in the symbol text:
Select the variable.
Click Up or Down (6). The variable changes its position in the table by one
step with every click. You can check the result in the preview.
3. Configure block
The display of a variable in the text block must often be supplemented by additional
characters in the pre-text or in the post-text in order to be able to appear as
understandable information. Additional adjustments are necessary in order to limit the
text length. Displaying the height of the object shall be used as an example:
(8) (9)
Basic functions
(13 (14
(10) (11)
configuration
• The status of "New line” (8) determines whether the block starts a new line
configuration
(checked) or attaches to the end of the previous line (unchecked).
• With "left" or "right" (9) you define the arrangement of the text in the row
(left/right justified).
• You can use any character or string of characters as pre-text (10) or post-text
extensions,
(11).
extensions,
• Input "Width" (13) and "Decimal" (14) are only displayed in the case of a
numeric variable. With Input "Width" you define the minimum width as number
of characters that will take the displayed value. Input "Decimal" determines the
number of decimal places displayed.
Adjustments,
• In the case of an alphanumeric variable (e.g. item) the fields (13) and (14) are
Adjustments,
named as "Min Width" and " Max Width". Adjust the number of characters.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
493
Introduction
Symbol numbering
(4)
(1)
(2)
(5)
Basic functions
(3)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The position marker is designed for continuous application. At the same time, for
some systems it is necessary to limit the number of components in a line or a group.
For example, a maximum of 64 EIB/KNX components are permitted in one line. For
monitoring, you can enter the maximum number in Input "Open dialogue after
number” (3). If you have placed the specified number of labels in the model, DDS-
CAD opens the dialogue automatically. By adapting the pre-text, you can define a
new line.
The settings for the frame (4) and reference line (5) have the same meaning as the
symbol text (see 19.4.1.1, page 488).
494
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Separator
Number
The number can be either a digit, a letter or a series of letters. Through continued
use, the subsequent numbers are assigned automatically:
Basic functions
AA … AB; AC; AD etc.
As with the symbol text, the position marker in the object can be applied enabled or
dynamically to the objects (cf. 19.4.1.2, page 489). The dynamic proposal is
displayed as the more appropriate option:
Select the "PositionMarker” function. The dialogue box (see above) appears.
Correct all settings and click OK . The cursor moves the label as a movable
symbol. It shows the set number.
configuration
configuration
Move the label to an object. The object is selected. This indicates that this num-
ber belongs to the selected object.
extensions,
Move the label to the desired position and fix it by clicking . The function re-
extensions,
mains active and already displays the next number. You can assign them to the
next object.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
495
Introduction
In the "PositionMarker” dialogue box there are preconfigured types for labelling
electrical engineering system parts. Some settings are fixed, they should not be
changed.
EIB/KNX (region/line/member)
When you call the type, you are given suggestions for pre-text,
number, and the number of labels. However, these can be changed.
The first two digits (region and line) are defined as pre-text. They
remain unchanged during application.
The last digit (member) corresponds to the number and is
incremented. Frame and reference line can also be activated. The
number of labels until the dialogue box is reopened is suggested with
64 and can be changed.
Emergency lighting
The frame is defined as a circle with centre line. The top figure is
suggested in the pre-text and can be adjusted. It remains unchanged
during application.
Basic functions
496
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.4.3 Free text
(1)
(3)
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
Enter the text in the input field (1). Text blocks (2) are stored in the UserText.txt file
as a template. You can edit the file and write new text blocks.
To set a font, choose "Style” (3). This selection accesses an attribute mapping,
in which the various styles are defined. DDS-CAD uses this as a template (see
configuration
also Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Error! Bookmark not
configuration
defined.).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
497
Introduction
(3) (2) (1) Select the symbol text by clicking . The text
appears as a selected object with the three
handles (1), (2) and (3). You can click a han-
dle and make the desired change in position.
Handle (1) only moves the text box. The tip of the
reference line remains directed to the old
position.
Basic functions
498
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Basic functions
delete existing
dimension points or
insert new ones.
(3)
A single dimension
Main dimension
type can be executed
in a maximum of two
planes. The main
dimension line shows
configuration
configuration
the sum of all sections
of a dimensional
chain, the sub-
dimension line shows
Sub-dimension Measure Selection Dimension the length of a section. extensions,
extensions,
Measures can be adjusted in the layout, the application of units of measurement and
rounding. A manual correction of content is not possible. The length of the dimension
helper lines results from the combination of different parameters and the selection
(between the sections of a dimensional chain) can be altered in terms of size and
symbol.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
499
Introduction
dimension line (main/sub) should appear on which side of a dimensional chain – top,
bottom, left or right. The graphic shows an example for each configuration.
Top (X distance)
Right (Y distance)
Left (Y distance)
Basic functions
Y
X
Bottom (X distance)
For the upper dimension type, main and sub dimension lines were selected. The
dimension types at the bottom and right side show only the main dimension line, the
left dimension type only shows the sub-dimension line. You can also see that with the
upper and lower dimension types, the X distances between the dimension points are
evaluated. The left and right dimension types consequently consider the Y distances.
500
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
19.5.2 General application
Application
Basic functions
Points captu-
Dimensionin
configuration
configuration
Activate snap points.
Select the "Points to be Dimensioned” function. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
The message line shows the following prompt: "Localize the first point of dimen-
sions...”..
extensions,
Move the cursor to the first reference point. The point captures the cursor and
extensions,
chain.
Adjustments,
Press [Enter]. The dimension type dialogue box is displayed (see 19.5.4,
page 504).
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
501
Introduction
(1)
The dimension type can be adjusted to any angle. The dimension figures are
corrected automatically.
Example situation
An oblique body edge has been
dimensioned and the dimension
lines are horizontal in the model.
However, they are to be rotated
parallel to the edge of the body.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
502
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Drawing and labelling Erro
r!
Application
Basic functions
Select the reference line. You
can move the start and end
nodes.
configuration
configuration
Correct the position. The dimen-
sion fits its position.
Call the object dialogue again
and disable "Set angle with
line A-B". The reference line is
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
503
Introduction
The properties of a dimension type are managed from an object dialogue. In the
"Dimensioning Points” tab, define the outer shape of a dimension, in the
"Parameters" tab, define the unit of measurement and rounding.
The "Dimensioning Points” tab is where you can alter the dimension type (1) and the
layout (2).
The text size is entered in decimeters (dm). For the selection, you can select a type
and alter its size by a factor. The value "1" is the default size. A factor < 1 reduces
the selection, a factor > 1 results in an enlargement.
Basic functions
Right-angle dimension: Starting the function, select dimension points, end the
function and configure dimension type
Subsequent moving
504
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
20 General editing functions
In this context, it may happen that you have accidentally selected one or more
objects. To remove them from the following editing operation (e.g. deleting) you can
deselect individual objects.
Selected objects are shown in blue and with a dashed line. Each selected object has
one or more handles, where you take hold of the objects and place them as dynamic
symbols.
Basic functions
You can call other editing functions from the context menu (click ) or via a keyboard
shortcut.
configuration
configuration
• Select object
• Remove selections
• Editing functions for selected objects
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
505
Introduction
All objects that are affected Keep pressed and move down
by a region and right. The cursor draws a rectan-
gle (red, dashed). All objects affected
by the region are selected.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
All objects that fully enclosed Keep pressed and move up and
by a region right. The cursor draws a rectangle
(red, solid line). All objects within the
region are selected.
Index
506
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
20.1.3 Remove selections
For all objects in the model Click once in the free workspace.
All selections are removed.
For all objects that are Keep pressed and move down
Basic functions
touched by a region and left. The cursor draws a rectan-
gle (green, dashed). The selection is
removed for all objects touched by
the region.
For all objects that are fully Keep pressed and move up and
enclosed by a region left. The cursor draws a rectangle
(green, solid line). The selection is
removed for all objects that are fully
enclosed by the region.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
507
Introduction
Copy The function writes the selected objects to the Windows clip-
[Ctrl]+[C] board. Reference is the mounting height of the last placed
object. Use [Ctrl]+[V] to insert this object into the model
once more.
Copy with free reference The function expects the definition of the reference point
point (click ) and writes the selected objects to the Windows
clipboard. Use [Ctrl]+[V] to insert this object into the model
once more.
Delete [Del] The selected objects are deleted from the model.
Basic functions
Move with free reference The selected objects are converted into dynamic symbols.
point They can be moved with the cursor and placed again with
the assistance of the symbol functions. The function expects
the definition of the reference point (click ).
Absolute Z-axis The function asks for the new height for the selected objects.
[Home] Enter the value in metres (m) and observe the effect of the
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
preceding + or - sign.
From the last point: The function asks for a difference, with which the selected
right/left/up/down objects are be moved in the direction indicated. Enter the
[]/[]/[]/[] value in metres (m) without a preceding + or - sign.
From the last point: The function asks for the difference to change the height.
Z-axis positive / negative Enter the value in metres (m) without a preceding + or - sign.
[PgUp] / [PgDn]
Index
508
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
Overview: Editing functions for selected objects
From the last point: The function asks for the differences by which the selected
According to relative coor- objects are moved in the X, Y and Z direction. Enter the val-
ues in metres (m) and observe the effect of the preceding +
dinates [8] or - sign.
From the last point: The function asks for the direction (as an angle) and distance
According to polar coordi- for the shift of the selected objects.
nates [9]
Rotate object freely The object is rotated about its mounting point with the cursor.
Click to fix it.
Zoom to selected object The zoom range is changed so that all selected objects are
[Shift]+[Z] fully visible on the screen.
Basic functions
Filter selected type from The function expects the definition of an area by which all
the range objects of the selected type (e.g. all openings) should be fil-
tered. Note the movement directions:
configuration
configuration
Open item documentation The function opens the document that is connected to the
item of the selected object.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
509
Introduction
Select the first operation to be undone in the change list by clicking (in this
case, row 8). All underlying entries are also marked. A single-line context menu
is displayed.
Select "Undo marked action(s)”.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
A separator line is inserted above the selected row. The status appears on the
screen up to the last operation above the separating line (in this case, row 7).
Check the status. Have you set the handle at the correct point?
Yes: Continue working as normal. The rows below the separating line are re-
jected.
No, I have to return: Repeat the procedure further up in the list.
No, I've gone too far: See "Wiederherstellen der markierten Zeilen" (Restoring
the selected rows).
510
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
Click on a row below the separator line. The selected row (and all rows above
the separator line) are selected. A single-line context menu is displayed.
Basic functions
Properties of
multiple objects
configuration
(1)
configuration
(2)
extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
511
Introduction
The possibilities of the function are extremely varied, the key step is filtering the
objects to be edited. You can use two strategies:
• Filter by template of a selected object (see 20.3.2, page 512)
• Manually define the properties of the search filter (see 20.3.3, page 513)
all objects that belong to the same component group as the reference object (e.g. all
windows, all electrical sockets or all washbasins). Special features, like item used or
the installation height are not considered.
Add same articles (6) filters all objects that use the same item as the reference object.
Application
Select the reference object (e.g. a window) by clicking .
Select the "Find and Edit Objects” function. The dialogue box is displayed. The
table contains a single entry (3).
Select a filter function (4), (5) or (6). All suitable objects are filtered and listed in
the table. These objects are selected in the model.
Edit the objects in the manner required.
Index
512
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
20.3.3 Manually define properties of the search filter
Application
Basic functions
Select the "Find and Edit Objects” function. The dialogue box is displayed. There
are no entries in the table.
Select the required object group (7).
Click Properties (8). The object dialogue of the selected object group is displayed.
It is used as an input form for the search filter. The input fields are blank.
Define all parameters that are to apply as search criteria. Search criteria can be
numeric values of certain dimensions (9), the item (10) and the setting of the pen
and layer inclusion (11).
Click OK . All suitable objects are filtered and listed in the table. These objects
configuration
are selected in the model.
configuration
Edit the objects in the manner required.
The "Move Area” function considers all objects and coordinates (e.g. the end of a
line) within a determined region. These are shifted by the same distance in the same
direction. The relationships between shifted and unshifted coordinates are retained
(i.e. lines may be extended or shortened).
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
513
Introduction
You have drawn a floor plan. Now the vertical wall shown in black is to be moved to
the left. The doors 1 and 2 are to be included in this operation.
Procedure
Select the "Move Area” function in the toolbox. The cursor
turns into a crosshair. The message line shows the following
prompt: "Enter point no 1 for the demarcation rectangle”.
Determine the movement area with two clicks :
Basic functions
If the shift is to be performed: Click on the reference point. The cursor moves
a dynamic line. The message line shows the following prompt: "Enter a point for
the move distance”
514
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
General editing functions Erro
r!
To shift in a certain direction, by a certain amount
Basic functions
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions, configuration
configuration
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
515
Introduction
Editing the source file is not a task that has to be performed in one step at a time. It
may be required at various times when encountering different situations. For
example, editing a freshly imported DWG/DXF file is the classical case, but this need
can also arise later. A step-by-step adjustment is of course possible, and often
recommended. Therefore, you can switch between the action areas "DDS Model"
and "DWG/DXF Editor" at any time.
Warning!
The "Undo" function is not available in the DWG/DXF
editor. For example, a deleted object cannot be restored.
Basic functions
In most cases – in the case of editing the floor plan – you start the DWG/DXF Editor
via the DDS model (see 21.1.1, page 516). However, if you want to isolate individual
symbols from the DWG/DXF file (for further use in the DDS model), start the Editor at
the program level (see 21.1.2, page 517).
21.1.1 On editing the floor plan: Starting from the DDS model
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the "Import- and Model Admin” function. The "Inserted file administrator”
dialogue box appears. This lists all imported objects in the model.
Select the import object by clicking . The context menu is displayed.
Select the "Open in new window” function. The DWG/DXF Editor is opened in a
new window. You have access to the contents of the DWG/DXF file.
Index
516
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
21.1.2 To transfer a symbol: Starting from the program level
(1)
Basic functions
Open the Project Menu. The "Project Menu” dialogue box appears.
Click Close (1). The program asks whether the changes in the current project
should be saved. Afterwards the project and all open drawings are closed. You
are taken to the program level.
configuration
Then start the DWG/DXF Editor in the "File" menu.
configuration
Open the DWG/DXF file and you can start editing.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
517
Introduction
518
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
Select objects outside of the zoom range
(1) Example:
The black square (1) symbolises an object or part of an area to
(2) be isolated. The light grey rectangle (2) represents the active
zoom range (screen view).
To select objects lying outside the area, select these functions from the "Edit” menu:
"...completely outside of the zoom area". Only objects completely outside of the
zoom area are selected. Objects that are partially visible are not selected and
therefore not deleted.
Basic functions
"...partially outside of the zoom area". All objects that are wholly or partly outside
of the zoom area are selected. Objects that are fully visible are not selected and
therefore not deleted.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions, configuration
configuration
DDS-CAD 7.3
519
Introduction
The layer structure of an imported DWG/DXF file will always differ from the DDS
layer structure. It may be that the imported file contains several layers that you want
to merge with layers in DDS-CAD. The layer structure of the DWG/DXF file should
then be transferred into the layer structure of DDS-CAD.
Procedure
Select "Format" menu "Assign DWG layers to a DDS layer" function. The "As-
sign DWG layers to a DDS layer" dialogue box is displayed.
Basic functions
Select the layer of the DWG/DXF file that you want to assign to a DDS layer.
Click Map . The "Select layer" dialogue box is displayed.
(1)
(2)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the DDS layer (1) to which you want to assign the DWG/DXF layer and
click OK (2). The assignment is shown.
Click OK . The settings are saved and apply for the entire project.
Index
520
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
21.2.3 Edit file properties
Basic functions
Application
configuration
file to the DDS model by adjusting the
configuration
drawing unit.
DDS-CAD 7.3
521
Introduction
With the "Insertion point (Origo) of the file" function you specify the zero point of the
DWG/DXF file to a defined position, and thus correct the insertion point of the import
object (see 18.1.3, page 398). You can use this operation, for example, to produce
the positionally correct arrangement of the storeys in the DDS model (see 4.3.3,
page 41).
Use
Select the insertion point (Origo) of the file. The cursor turns into a crosshair.
Press [Shift] and move the cursor to the desired position of the insertion point.
The point captures the cursor and holds it tight. The character of the point and its
coordinates are displayed.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Click . The "Insertion point (Origo) of the file" dialogue box is displayed. This
shows the displacement of the insertion point (Origo) on the X, Y and Z coordi-
nates.
The values for X and Y may not be changed. However, make sure that Z=0 and
click OK . The operation is ended. You can continue the work.
Index
522
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
Basic functions
(1)
(5)
(2)
configuration
(3)
configuration
extensions,
extensions,
(4)
The graphic shows the part drawing of a DWG/DXF file from the perspective of the
Adjustments,
DWG/DXF Editor (left) and the DDS model (right). The file contains an electrical
Adjustments,
engineering design and the properties (2) for the two labelled double sockets (1) are
displayed:
Both sockets are symbolised by the insert object "ST03" (3), for which a link to a DDS
item (4) has been created in the "Artikel-Zuordnung" (Map symbol) tab. By saving the
link, you switch back to the DDS model. A DDS object (5) is placed at each position
of a "ST03" object.
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
523
Introduction
the successfully linked insert objects are hidden in the DWG/DXF Editor. It is
therefore necessary to switch between the two action areas several times.
Note:
The item mapping is not possible if only geometric functions were used when
creating the DWG/DXF (such as circles, rectangles, lines). Admittedly, this creates
a visual symbol, but not a usable object.
The link between the insert object in the DWG/DXF file to the DDS item can be
produced both at the individual object (the "Properties" dialogue) or by using an
administration function in a table. Then, the changes are saved and the position of
objects corrected.
Warning!
Before starting this operation, the correct position of the storeys must be checked
and corrected if necessary. If you skip this step, the transferred objects will be in
the wrong position in the model. Please refer to chapter 4.3.3, page 41.
Basic functions
(1)
(2)
(3)
Call a single object (e.g. a double socket, ST03) by double clicking . The
"Properties (selected object)" is displayed.
Switch to the "Map symbol" tab and select the application type (1) and the DDS
item group (2).
Click Select DDS item (3). The product database is displayed and allows you to se-
lect an item.
Index
524
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
Select the item. The selected item is transferred into the "Properties (selected
object)" dialogue.
This operation can be realised quickly and easily. In addition, you automatically
check the symbol for its suitability:
Basic functions
You can see whether it has been
inserted as a insert object (left) and
thus suitable for linking or whether it
was created by a combination of
different functions (right). In this case
you cannot create a link.
configuration
For a large variety of objects in large-scale drawings, however, the overview may get
configuration
lost. You can forget about objects or call them many times unnecessarily. You also
have no information about the frequency of an object. Therefore, you should use the
following method as a supplement.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
525
Introduction
Linking insert objects with matching DDS items can be done with the assistance of a
central management function. This function displays all the objects in an overview,
the frequency of their use (1) and the associated DDS item (2). A preview window (3)
shows an image of the selected object:
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
(4)
(3) (5)
(6)
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
526
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
21.3.4 Save object mapping and transfer to the DDS model
Apply changes
(1)
(4)
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
Application
Select the "Apply changes" function. The "Apply changes" dialogue box is dis-
played.
Check "Apply changes made in symbol-mapping” (1).
Select an option (2) according to your requirements. For more information,
configuration
please see 21.4, page 531.
configuration
Click OK . The DDS model is displayed on the screen. The selected DDS ob-
jects are placed at the positions of the associated insert objects (DWG/DXF).
Position and rotation of the DDS objects do not have to be identical to the origi-
nal, the correction takes place in the next step. extensions,
Warning!
extensions,
"Forget history of mapped symbols...” (4) leads to another transfer of all existing
links to the DDS model. DDS-CAD ignores the existing objects and places new
objects at the corresponding positions.
Note the impact this has on the part list. Use this function for example, for a
Adjustments,
DDS-CAD 7.3
527
Introduction
In these cases, you have to correct the position of objects in the DDS model.
However, you do not have to replace any individual object. It is sufficient if (as in the
example) you edit a single double socket. DDS-CAD asks if this change should be
transferred to all objects of the same type:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Warning!
If you answer with No , this mode is ended and can no longer be activated.
Therefore, first correct all objects before going on to refine the model.
528
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
(1)
Basic functions
Open the DWG/DXF file in the Editor (see 21.1, page 516).
Select the "Choose the article to assosiate with” function. The table is displayed.
Check "Hide inserted symbols from DXF model" (1) and click OK . All
DWG/DXF objects that were connected with a DDS item disappear.
Save the changes in the DWG/DXF file (see 21.4, page 531). The DDS model is
configuration
configuration
displayed on the screen. The linked insert objects (DWG/DXF) are hidden, only
the DDS objects are visible:
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index extensions,
extensions,
DDS-CAD 7.3
529
Introduction
Linking DWG/DXF objects with DDS items and their transfer into the DDS model is a
useful tool when working with DDS-CAD. As a result of this operation, you can
quickly and easily end up with a part list. This list is always dependent on the
available data and must be evaluated in this context.
In 21.3.2 we talked about the symbol of a lamp, which is only created by the drawing-
related combination of geometric objects. It was shown that linking is not possible for
this example, and therefore it has no effect on the part list. Negative or incorrect
effects are to be expected, however, whenever a symbol has been combined from
objects that are suitable for linking.
Example
In the graphic, you can see a symbol that represents a four-way socket. However, in
creating the DWG/DXF file, the object was a single socket object with an additional
caption:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
This state of affairs results in a single socket being transferred into the DDS model
and thus in the part list.
Note:
Please note that the result of the part list is always dependent on the available
data.
Index
530
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the DWG/DXF editor Erro
r!
Apply changes
Basic functions
editing the DWG/DXF file and do not want to transfer
these to the DDS model.
Apply changes made in the drawing, but do NOT save the DWG/DXF file
This option is only useful if you have created a link between DWG/DXF objects and
DDS items as per chapter 21.3 (from page 523). This setting only allows the mapping
of objects to the DDS model. Any changes to the drawing in the DWG/DXF file are
ignored.
configuration
configuration
Apply changes made in the drawing AND save the DWG/DXF file
All changes (object mapping and drawing-related editing) are saved. Changes to the
drawing are written directly into the current DWG/DXF file. Select this option if you
have made a repeated post edit.
drawing are saved by creating a new DWG/DXF file. After confirming with OK
DDS-CAD asks for the name of the new file.
Select this option if you have received a new DWG/DXF file and save it after the first
edit. Thus you protect the original file by creating a new one. You can access it later
again if necessary.
Adjustments,
Adjustments,
Index
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
531
Part IV – Adjustments
Adjustments
DDS-CAD 7.3
532
Introduction Strategies for handling projects Basic functions Adjustments, extensions, configuration Index
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
22 Working with the product database
Drawing operation
Product database Item: Lamp
*.ARD
Number, description
Lamps
Output, size
Sockets
Distribution Symbol
board
Basic functions
DDS model
Object: Lamp
Item
Position
Conclusion:
Always distinguish between the terms "object", "item" and "symbol"! The article is
a property of the object. The symbol is a property of the item.
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
533
Introduction
The visible symbol is a property of the item. However, it is not part of the product
database, but rather an independent data record. The symbol is only accessed via an
addressing in the item settings. It is therefore not just a case of distinguishing the
term "item" and "symbol" logically: they are actually different data types.
An item is always part of a product database (*.ARD). It can only be called, used or
manipulated via the database interface (see 22.2, page 536).
A symbol is always a drawing file, whose file name follows a fixed format. It is either
stored as an open file in one of three hierarchical levels (see below) or packaged into
a symbol library (*.LIB).
You do not have direct access to symbols within a symbol library. However, you can
copy a symbol from the library and use it as a template for a new symbol. This
procedure is simpler than constructing one from scratch. You can modify the
template and save it under a new name (see 23.1, page 545).
Basic functions
USER
The folder is designed to store all company-specific adaptations. This will include for
example, your logo for the drawing stamp, your own symbols, title boxes, legends
and even product databases. These data are available in all projects. The path for
this folder is set during the installation routine.
Warning
Copy the projects and also the "USER" folder to your backup!
Index
534
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
22.1.3 Application of the hierarchy, search mechanisms
Basic functions
finds the desired symbol in this
1 2 n 1 2 n chain, it is accessed and can be
displayed in the model. If none of
the search queries are successful,
DDS-CAD gives an error message.
Yes
found?
This relationship is best explained
No using the example of a logo:
Yes
found?
You have created your company's
No logo and saved it in the "USER"
No
DDS-CAD 7.3
535
Introduction
By default, the management interface for the product database displays the contents
of all three hierarchy levels. However, you can disable the display of the USER and
SYS product databases, by checking "Show only used products”. In this case, the
table only lists the items that have actually been used at least once in the current
project.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The project product database is created when you access the first object in a new
project. The requested item is automatically taken from the USER or the SYS product
database and written into the project product database. The size of the project
product database grows with the variety of objects used. If you create a new item,
this is also part of the active project product database.
You create and manage the USER product database through an administration
process. Perform this step if you have created new items and want to use them in all
other projects. The procedure is described in 22.2.3, page 538.
The SYS product database is installed and maintained by DDS. You have only read
permission.
Index
536
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
22.2.2 Item search
(2)
(1)
Basic functions
(3)
The example shows the string "Wall" in the first search box for the item description.
DDS-CAD now searches through all item descriptions in the current filter for that
string. The display in the table is narrowed down accordingly. You can limit the
display further, if you use additional search boxes (see below). The table lists items
containing the strings "Wall" and "Partition".
(3)
You can save your searches. To do this, check the checkbox next to the search box
(3).
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
537
Introduction
You can expand the product database for the current project (project product
database) or for all projects (USER product database):
First, decide
A new item to be created whether the new
item is to be
available only for the
current project or for
For the all projects. This is
current project
important if you want
or for all?
to keep the USER
product database
Current project All projects
"clean" and
structured. Because
Remain in the project Project: Chapter 22.2.3.1
Page 539 ALL new or changed
_700-DDS- items are transferred
Artikel
open/create
from a project to
Chapter 22.2.3.2
USER, no
differentiation is
Basic functions
Page 539
Call function, copy item possible.
project
need to observe any
special features.
Use item
You can them duplicate any item and edit the copy. Correct the description of the
item, its technical parameters and the link to a symbol if necessary.
If the edited items are to be transferred to USER, perform the necessary admin step.
Index
538
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
22.2.3.1 The project "_700-DDS-Artikel" – The item workshop
Basic functions
22.2.3.2 Create new item by copying
Start the function (e.g. "Builders Work”). The product database is displayed.
Select a suitable item (to be copied copy) and click . The context menu is dis-
played.
Select the "Copy" function. The entry is duplicated. The item ID number is gen-
erated automatically and the item description begins with the word "copy". You
can edit the copy and customise its properties.
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
539
Introduction
You can change any item, configure its technical properties and alter its visual
representation in the model.
(1)
(2)
(3)
Basic functions
(4)
(5)
Select the copy of the item by clicking . The context menu is displayed.
Select the "Edit” function. The "Change Product” dialogue box is displayed.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
The description (the item) is the text that appears in the item selection and also in the
part list. For the description, you can use 256 characters of any kind.
Note
The entered number is irrelevant, if a path to an external symbol has been entered
in Input "External Symbol" (5) (see below)
Index
540
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
Input "External info" (4)
You can place any document (e.g. PDF file, Excel spreadsheet, text document, etc.)
Enter the full path to the document, noting the syntax rules:
If you have assigned a document to the item, you can open it from the model:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the object in the model by clicking .
Open the context menu (click ).
Select the "Show product sheet” function.
DDS-CAD 7.3
541
Introduction
Warning!
The function transfers ALL amended items in the current project to USER. To
avoid filling your USER product database with redundant entries, only perform this
operation if:
- you are in your item workshop (the project "_700-DDS-Artikel")
- you are sure that ALL edited items can be copied to USER
(1)
(2)
Basic functions
(3)
Select the "Admin" function. The "Export to User Product Database” dialogue
box appears. The default settings correspond to the intended target: The source
product database is in the current project (1). From this, all changed items (2)
are copied to the user product database (3).
Click OK . All new and modified items have been copied to the USER data-
base and are thus available in all projects.
Index
542
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Working with the product database Erro
r!
22.2.4 Working with the manufacturer database (electrical)
Basic functions
Select the "Extra product databases" function. The "Select Manufacturer Data-
base(s)" dialogue is displayed, listing all available records with a description of
the content.
Select the desired data record and click Load . The data record is denoted as
active by the "x" character.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. You can use the items from that manu-
facturer.
DDS-CAD 7.3
543
Introduction
Select the "Extra Product Database" function. The "Select Manufacturer Data-
base(s)" dialogue is displayed, listing all available records with a description of
the content.
Select the desired data record and click Load . The data record is denoted as
active by the "x" character.
Click OK . The dialogue box is closed. You can use the items from that manu-
facturer.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
544
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23 Symbol creation
Switch icon no. 901 (2D) Switch icon no. 901 (3D)
S11901.bi S13901.bi
Keyword of the Keyword of the
component group component group
"1" = 2D version "3" = 3D version
Symbol number Symbol number
The keyword defines the use of the symbol for a certain component group within the
Basic functions
product database (see table below).
55
The digits "1" or "3" control the display. Each symbol exists as a 2D and 3D
version, which appears as a schematic symbol in the plan view, but as a three-
dimensional object in the 3D view. Therefore each object requires two symbols!
The symbol ID is used as the address in the properties of the item (see 22.2.3.3,
page 540). For your symbols, use the numbers 900 to 999.
55
The only exceptions are title fields and legends (see xxx).
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
545
Introduction
The user interface during symbol creation differs in some respects from the user
interface during project work:
546
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Project menu Import and drawing manager (page 80)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
547
Introduction
The contents of the title fields can be divided into four categories: the wireframe (1),
the logogram (2), unchangeable text (3) and dynamic information (4), which are read
56
as a text block from the project, drawing and revision data dialogue boxes.
The default width of a title field is 18m. While maintaining this width, you can use it
Basic functions
either in the left or right bottom corner of a sheet via the "Title field/stamp" dialogue
box, without having to move it dynamically. If the width ≠ 18m, it can only be used
right/dynamic or left/dynamic. Bear this in mind when setting up the wireframe (see
xxx).
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
57
Title fields can be scaled, like any other object . Before developing a new title field,
you should decide whether there is a need for re-sizing. The answer to this question
is crucial for the incorporation of text and text blocks, as they only adjust their sizes
using a specific combination of commands in the symbols.
56
see 16.3.5, page 375
57
Changing the size on the basis of a factor (factor <1 causes a reduction; factor >1 causes an enlargement)
Index
548
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
following section). However, if you want to draw a new field title (without using a
template) observe the notes given in xxx.
(3) (4)
Basic functions
drawing (2). The pattern
(3) shows the proportions
of a DDS title field. Use
this as a guide for building
the wireframe. Slide the
logo and the prepared text
blocks (4) into the desired
positions.
DDS-CAD 7.3
549
Introduction
> 18 m = 18 m < 18 m
Basic functions
58
They must be removed once you have finished editing.
59
See 19.3, page 491.
Index
550
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
The fourth step is to shift the required
Basic functions
Once completed, the title field must
be cleaned up and stored in the
USER directory as a symbol file:
Delete any remaining (surplus)
Generate title field entries and text.
Select the "Generate title field"
function. A message indicates
that the title field has been saved
under a specific name in the
USER directory.
DDS-CAD 7.3
551
Introduction
Create
drawing file Chapter 23.1.1
Scalability
Page 545
of title fields
Construct
lattice frame
construct with: supported by:
and declare it as part of the object. Use the following file names in accordance with
60
the naming convention for DDS symbols :
• TF1901.BIM (for your first title field)
• TF1902.BIM (for your second title field)
• TF19nn.BIM (consecutive numbering for additional title fields)
Special text commands must be used for static text: TH, TC, TV, TR are
used
The text height is not set directly but rather determined by integrated
calculations
2. The title field should read the contents of the project and drawing data as
blocks
see Hiba! A hivatkozási forrás nem található., page Hiba! A könyvjelző nem létezik.
60
Index
552
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.1.2.4 Using a title field
61
A symbol is a combination of geometric and functional elements . The geometric
functions are accessed from the toolbox, their application is described in chapter 19,
from page 431. In addition, please note the following:
Basic functions
Warning!
Geometric objects within a symbol must
remain neutral with regards to layer and
pen assignment. Otherwise, the layer
management layer cannot affect the sym-
bol in its display. Therefore, choose the
settings shown for layers and pens.
Insert point
61
In many cases, you can create a new symbol based on an already existing symbol. You can choose a suitable template in the
symbol catalogue and apply this to your new symbol (see xxx).
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
553
Introduction
Right justified TR
Centred TC
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Side
Index
554
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
(3) You should always finish editing the symbol with a point at the position of the zero
point (see position 6 in the example).
Basic functions
Select the "Insert point” function. The cursor turns into a cross-
hair.
Click on the desired position. A red "+" appears at the se-
lected position. The function is ended.
Insert point
DDS-CAD 7.3
555
Introduction
symbols.
(1)
(2)
556
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Type Vertical/horizontal alignment Example Rotation
The functions described in this section are text-only functions. They are not related to
automatic annotation and labelling functions or text symbols. The text is configured
by a command (TH, TV, TL, TR or TC) in terms of size, line spacing and font. Then it
Basic functions
is written and confirmed line by line:
This function causes the entered text to be written horizontally from left to right from
the reference point. After activating this function, an input window is displayed, in
which the following settings can be made:
After confirming the input, you get to the text entry field.
Each line of text is entered in this field and confirmed with OK.
Afterwards this screen is displayed again. You can continue entering the next line
or stop the function here.
DDS-CAD 7.3
557
Introduction
Variable information that is to be displayed as text in the model can, by using the TT
62
command, be retrieved from the project, drawing and revision data dialogue boxes.
In principle, you can use this function anywhere, but it is mainly used to design title
fields. The graphic shows the relationship using global project information as an
example:
Basic functions
The position of a text block can be based on one or between two reference points.
The font is automatically decided by the a setting in the TT command. Therefore first
specify the by first specifying a single point. You then call the TT command via the
input box. Two dialogue boxes are displayed one after the other, which are used to
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
From which
...should the
From which drawing... information be taken?
62
cf. 16.3.5, page 375
Index
558
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Parameters of the first query
Basic functions
-2 "Created" editor's character
-11 "Tested" date
-12 "Tested" editor's character
-21 Three-digit drawing or sheet number (not is dialogue 1 and 4)
-22 from project data Project name
from drawing data Full file name of the drawing
from sheet information Not active
From revision data Index of the revision entry
DDS-CAD 7.3
559
Introduction
560
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.1.4 Notes on installation and labelling symbols
All functions are grouped together in "Installation and labelling symbols" working
mode.
(3)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Select the "Installation and labelling symbols" working mode (1).
From the "Help" menu "Symbol catalogue" (2). The symbol catalogue is dis-
played as a help window.
Find a suitable template, and note the file name (3)
Select the copy function (4, see below, in this case "Copy 2D symbol installation
-> edit)". The "CI" dialogue box appears.
Enter the code of the master template (here s11001) and click OK . The "In-
sert command file" dialogue box is displayed.
Click OK . The template is displayed on screen.
Select "Clean up symbol". You can start designing.
DDS-CAD 7.3
561
Introduction
562
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Most symbols are summarised in libraries and stored in the SYS directory. However,
you do not have direct access to this database. However, you can copy a symbol
from the library and use it as a template for a new symbol. This process is described
using an example:
Basic functions
Draw symbol
Connection and
identification points
Scalable text
Chapter Hiba!
A hivatkozási
forrás nem Material mapping for
rendering
Draw symbol
Connection and
identification points
Chapter Hiba!
Material mapping for
A hivatkozási
rendering
forrás nem
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
563
Introduction
The naming convention for DDS symbols must be respected if the symbol is to work.
The structure of the file name is explained with a switch:
Switch icon no. 401 (2D) Switch icon no. 401 (3D)
S11401.bim S13401.bim
Keyword of the Keyword of the
component group component group
The keyword is an internal command to call the component group. The following
table lists all keywords and their contents:
Command Command
and application and application
Weak current total up to version
E1 LB Light rail (without bulbs)
6.24, not included in version 6.3x
E2 Telephone, data equipment LF Fluorescent lamps
Alarm systems and monitoring
E3 LG Legends
equipment (intrusion, fire, video)
Incandescent bulbs, light outlets,
E4 Bell, intercom and PA systems LI
spotlights
E5 Antennas and satellite dishes S1 Switching devices
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Almost every symbol exists as a 2D and 3D version. Therefore each object requires
two symbol files! The only exceptions are title fields and legends. In this way it is
ensured that a schematic symbol appears in the plan view and a three-dimensional
object in the 3D view.
The symbol ID is used throughout the product database (see 22.2.3.3, page 540).
Use the numbers 900 to 999 for your symbols.
Index
564
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
A new symbol is to be developed for a switching device. It is assumed that the
symbol catalogue contains a template that can be copied, modified and can be saved
To be able to use the new symbol in all projects, the drawing file must be stored in
the USER directory.
(4)
(3)
Basic functions
(2) (1)
Start the drawings list. The "Project Menu” dialogue box appears.
Click more >> (1). The "Project Menu” dialogue enables additional functions.
Click User dir. (2). DDS-CAD leaves the directory of the current project and goes to
the USER directory.
DDS-CAD 7.3
565
Introduction
The naming convention for DDS symbols must be respected if the symbol is to work.
The structure of the file name is explained with a boiler:
Boiler icon no. 401 (2D) Boiler icon no. 401 (3D)
GF2401.bin GF3401.bin
Keyword of the Keyword of the
component group component group
The keyword is an internal command to call the component group. The following
table lists all keywords and their contents:
Command
Meaning, content and Command
Meaning, content and
Basic functions
application application
BA Bathtub LG Legends
Operating equipment, irrigation
BI SI Washbasin
and drainage
Assembly equipment, mounting
BK SW Outlet fitting
accessories
FH Fire extinguisher TF Title field (see 23.7, page 584)
Heat generators, tanks, safety
GF WC Toilet, urinal
equipment
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Almost every symbol exists as a 2D and 3D version. Therefore each object requires
two symbol files! The only exceptions are title fields and legends. In this way it is
ensured that a schematic symbol appears in the plan view and a three-dimensional
object in the 3D view.
The symbol ID is used throughout the product database (see 22.2.3.3, page 540).
Use the numbers 900 to 999 for your symbols.
Index
566
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
A new symbol is to be developed for a boiler. It is assumed that the symbol catalogue
To be able to use the new symbol in all projects, the drawing file must be stored in
the USER directory.
(4)
(3)
Basic functions
(2) (1)
Start the drawings list. The "Project Menu” dialogue box appears.
Click more >> (1). The "Project Menu” dialogue enables additional functions.
Click User dir. (2). DDS-CAD leaves the directory of the current project and goes to
the USER directory.
DDS-CAD 7.3
567
Introduction
In many cases, you can create a new symbol based on an already existing symbol.
You can choose a suitable template in the symbol catalogue and apply this to your
new symbol. All functions are grouped together in "Installation and labelling symbols"
working mode.
(3)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
568
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.2.3.2 Notes on the copy function and symbol codes
Basic functions
Copy 2D symbol general/architecture->edit
Use this function when developing a symbol for the "Kennzeichnung/Allgemeine
Symbole (Diverse)" (Labelling/general symbols (various)) area. In the "CI" dialogue,
enter the symbol code for the 2D version the symbol (e.g. T31001).
DDS-CAD 7.3
569
Introduction
(2) (3)
The general geometric functions are described in chapter 19.2, from page 462. The
following sections include notes on the functions
• Define point (see 23.1.3.2, page 555)
• Connection and label point (electrical) (see 23.1.3.3, page 556)
•
Basic functions
Warning!
Select these settings
for layers and pens for
all objects within a
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
symbol.
(2) At position 5 in the command list you will see the EP command. This is the
definition of a connection and label point for an electrical line. The position of this
connection point must be defined beforehand. In the parameters of the command MO
Index
570
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
(position 4 on the command list), the values for the X and Y coordinates have been
set to the value "0.5".
Insert point
Basic functions
Construct point
Enter the command MO and press [Enter].
The "Collect Points” dialogue box appears.
Enter the shift in metres (m). The preceding +
or - sign determines the direction on the axis.
Click OK . The point has been moved.
DDS-CAD 7.3
571
Introduction
572
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.2.4.4 Connection point – IP
Basic functions
Note:
If the starting direction of the line is to be any direction from the line, enter the
value "0" for Input "DirVer" and Input "DirHor". You can draw the pipe in any
direction after starting it.
DDS-CAD 7.3
573
Introduction
ended.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
574
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Basic functions
Creating and editing Chapter 22.2.3
new items Page 538
Use item
DDS-CAD 7.3
575
Introduction
Entry Meaning
symbol1.cfi Example name for the plan view
symbol1.cfi Example name for the 3D view
Name of an auxiliary symbol for the electrical connection. These entries are
Basic functions
ep1
required if the symbol is to be connected electrically.
The entries are separated by semicolons. After confirming with OK this item can
be used with all functions. It may be necessary to adjust the scaling.
Warning!
A wide range of 3DS objects is available online. Please note that some of these
may be fee-based. Copyright issues must be respected.
Index
576
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.5.1.1 Determining the file name and size of the new logo
First you need to know what the new logo must be called and what size it has to be to
be used in the tile field:
From the "Insert” menu select "Prepare for print" "Title field/stamp". The "
Title field/stamp" dialogue box is displayed.
Basic functions
Click … . The product database is displayed:
(1) (2)
(1) shows the logo's file name, (2) shows its size in metres (m).
DDS-CAD 7.3
577
Introduction
The first step is to create a drawing file for the new logo. You also have to decide
whether it should behave as a default for all projects or whether it should be project-
specific:
(1)
(2) (3)
Start the drawings list. The "Project Menu” dialogue box is displayed.
Click more >> (1). The dialogue enables additional functions.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
In the next step you decide the availability of the new logo:
As a project-specific logo
Click Directory (3). DDS-CAD remains in the current project directory:
Index
578
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
The description below is based on the default version for all projects.
(5):
(4) (5)
Basic functions
23.5.1.3 Designing the logo
Select the working mode "WM: Create logo". The toolbar changes and enables
additional functions.
Create WM logo
(1) (2)
(5)
(1) Define border with 6m x 1.5m (standard size for almost all title fields)
(2) Import graphics files
(3) Import DWG/DXF files
(4) Enter text
(5) Use geometric functions and crosshatching
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
579
Introduction
If you have finished designing the logo, you have to save the drawing (1) and then
export in the *CFI format (2):
(1) (2)
Basic functions
is a simple bitmap.
Warning!
Only edit the content, not the size of the image!
Index
580
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Apply legend
Creating and editing new Chapter 22.2.3
items Page 538
Basic functions
Use item
(1)
(3)
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
581
Introduction
Open a template and first save this template with a new file name. Select "File”
menu "Save As” function. The "Speichern unter" (Save as) dialogue box is
displayed.
Enter a new file name. Only change the last three digits of the original name.
Example: The legend Lege1000.BIM is used as an example in this description.
As a new file name, enter e.g. Lege1100.BIM (3).
Click Save . The modified legend has been saved as a new template in the
"_700-DDS-Legenden" project.
Edit the new legend to your requirements.
Now correct the drawing data of the new legend. This step provides a better overview
in the "_700-DDS-Legenden" project:
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
582
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.6.1.2 Export legend to CFI
Select "File” "Export" "Export CFI”. The "Export file" dialogue box is dis-
Basic functions
played.
The CFI file must be exported to the USER directory so that it can be used in all
projects. Therefore, enter the path to the USER directory (1). The file name can
remain the same, however, you can use any file name you like.
Click Save . The CFI file of the new legend is exported to the USER directory.
You can close the drawing and use the legend in your projects.
DDS-CAD 7.3
583
Introduction
23.7.1 ((Introduction))
The title field is an object that can read text blocks from the project, drawing and
revision data and copy them to the symbol.
3. The title field should be called with the default function and used as an item.
A new symbol must be created in the user directory. The file name must be
based on the TF19xx naming convention.
Afterwards an item has to be created that will access the new symbol.
6. The title field should read the contents of the project and drawing data as
blocks
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Challenges/tasks
• Create a drawing
• Construct wireframe
584
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
23.7.2 Creating a title field from a template
Basic functions
23.7.2.1 Open, edit and save a template
(1)
(2)
(3) (4)
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
585
Introduction
to the size of the "Standard 1 size" existing title field. To the right (4) there are all
the wildcards for the project, drawing and revision dates, as well as the logo-
gram.
Duplicate the drawing in order to leave the template intact for future title fields.
Select "File” menu "Save As” function. The "Save As” dialogue box is dis-
played.
Create a new title field drawing with the name DDS_1001.BIM and click Save .
You have created a new template that you can now edit.
Once you have opened the new title field drawing, you can start designing your title field.
The individual actions are:
• Design the layout
• Correct the logo position
• Correcting the text block position
Basic functions
586
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Symbol creation Erro
r!
Correcting the text block position
Basic functions
23.7.2.3 Tidying up and generating a title field
If the title field is complete, it needs to be tidied up and saved in the USER directory
using a specified naming convention:
Delete all remaining (surplus) entries and text, but not the "pattern for size ratio"
(this is removed automatically in the next step).
Select the "Generate title field" function. A message indicates that the title field has
been saved under a specific name in the USER directory.
Click OK . The "Apply changes?" prompt is displayed.
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
587
Introduction
(1) (2)
Select the USER directory (1) and enter the file name (2).
TF1901.BIM (for your first title field)
TF1902.BIM (for your second title field)
TF19nn.BIM (consecutive numbering for additional title fields)
Basic functions
588
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
24 Custom circuit layouts
Position
Chapter 24.6 equipment
Page 598
Draw
wiring Chapter 24.7
Page 602
Basic functions
Close editing
mode
several existing
circuits Chapter 24.8
Page 603
Both complexes are discussed in the chapters 24.2 to 24.6. The descriptions use
terms that are first explained in 24.1.
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
589
Introduction
From a system
layout, you can derive your own, customised layouts. You can edit the circuit, save
the layout with a new name and then use it. By checking "Custom layouts" you can
control access to customised or system layouts.
The graphic shows that there is a correlation between the codes of the selected
layout of the basic equipment (above) and the listed custom layouts (4). This
indicates that a custom layout is always derived from a template.
The following sections explain some important terms that are used later on.
Index
590
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
24.1.2 System layout
Basic functions
AC template for other
ZZF1A- layouts. It uses the
AD code of the original
Variants of system layout, and
ZZF3A ZZF3A- passes it on to other
ZZF3A
AA custom layouts.
ZZF3A-
AB
In this way, several
variations are
created from one system layout. They are given the consecutive suffix "AA"; "AB";
"AC" etc.
The first variant "AA" has been derived from the system layout ZZF1A (light with
MCB, single pole). The following variants "AB" and "AC" are derived from "AA".
Finally, "AD" was re-created on the basis of the system layout. All four custom
layouts, however, are variants of the system layout ZZF1A.
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
591
Introduction
Each new variant of a circuit layout requires several types for flexible use in different
situations. This need arises from the fact that a circuit
a) can be illustrated in single-pole and multi-pole representation.
b) the electrical connection is configured using the following parameters:
- assignment to a level
- number of phase conductors used
- use of neutral and earth
The relationships are described by the following example:
Circuit F3 uses a custom layout. For this reason, the system layout ZZF1A was taken
as the starting point and expanded. The contactor contact (K1) was inserted and
bridged by switch (S1).
On the first sheet (left) you will see that circuit F3 draws its voltage directly from
level 1. By switching in the circuit table, this circuit should now tap from level 2.
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
By switching from level 1 to level 2, DDS-CAD uses a different type of the new
variant. Because this type does not yet exist, first the system layout is again used as
a template. In the picture on the right, you can see that the same components are
contained in the circuit, but the new circuit does not yet exist for this type. The layout
must therefore be re-created.
Mathematically, this relationship results in a large number of types for each variant.
Effectively, a new type only has to be developed when needed. DDS-CAD
automatically indicates this. This is the case:
Index
592
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
a) when creating a new circuit in the circuit table
Go to the reported circuit and open it for editing (see 24.2, page 594). The layout
manager is displayed.
Basic functions
Click Edit . You are taken to editing mode.
Correct and save the circuit. All circuits that have caused this error message use
the corrected type of this layout variant. The error message disappears after a
screen refresh for these circuits.
Case d)
This case is solved directly via the layout manager. You can only use a variant if the
required type already exists. The layout manager prompts you to create the type
through Edit .
DDS-CAD 7.3
593
Introduction
If the selected circuit has been created with a system layout, for which there are no
additional variants, you go straight to the editing mode. The previous changes in the
circuit table (e.g. changes to the number of poles, additional components) are
transferred to the editing mode and re-used. You can start building the circuit. Please
refer to chapter 24.4, page 595.
594
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
New
The function creates a new custom layout for the current project. The starting point is
the layout that the selected circuit uses. The previous changes in the circuit table
(e.g. changes to the number of poles, additional components) are transferred to the
Basic functions
editing mode and re-used. After the operation you can access the new variant.
Edit
The function starts the editing mode for the selected custom layout. You can edit both
the circuit and the description. This is queried again when you leave the editing mode
(see 24.7, page 602).
Warning!
The drawing-related editing of a circuit is applied to all circuits of the project that
use the modified circuit layout.
The function assigns the variant selected in the list to the circuit and closes the
dialogue. The circuit is then shown with the selected switching. As a prerequisite, the
required type (see 24.1.5, page 592) is available.
Note:
If you want to reassign an existing circuit to its original system layout, open the
"Circuits” cell in the circuit table by double clicking. Uncheck "Custom layout"
(1
DDS-CAD 7.3
595
Introduction
C
Basic functions
Y X
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
(1) (2)
The drawing surface (A) allows work on the circuit (1) that you have opened. It is
displayed in its original colours and contains all the elements that have been
confirmed up to this point in the circuit table. The coordinate system is located at the
intersection between the first branching conductor and the phase conductor L1. The
placeholder "Next layout" (2) controls the distance to the next circuit. The other
circuits remain visible in order to visualise the space. For better distinction, they are
displayed lighter.
In DDS Explorer (B) you will see that a library is open (DC-Edit.LIB) in which you are
now working. The names (in this case DU3ZZ-ZZF1A-02AB) are automatically
administered by DDS-CAD.
At the bottom of the screen you have access to the distribution (C). The opened
circuit is highlighted in the table and can be reconfigured. You can replace or delete
existing equipment and add new equipment. In this way you define the item selection
algorithm, if you call the circuit layout via the "New Circuit” dialogue. The possibilities
and limitations are described in the following chapter 24.5.
Index
596
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
The tool box (D) has specific functions available that are suitable for drawing-related
editing and addition to the circuitry (see 24.6, page 598).
Basic functions
All changes are immediately visible on the screen. You can then correct the positions
of the components.
DDS-CAD 7.3
597
Introduction
A symbol (e.g. switch, contact) only opens existing lines that are already included in
the system layout. If you need to add new lines to the circuit, you should first place
the components and then integrate them with the circuit through new lines.
Warning!
(1) The circuit's access to the potential, i.e. the connection to
a busbar must not be deleted. The positions of the
connections cannot be changed.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
598
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
Editing existing wiring lines
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
599
Introduction
Start and connection can also be performed directly at a break point. This break point
is converted into a wiring point.
Index
600
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
Move wiring point
Basic functions
Select the desired branch.
DDS-CAD 7.3
601
Introduction
If you have finished editing the circuit layout, you can exit the editing mode:
This function controls the naming (1), storage (2) and use (3) of the circuit layout.
Apply
The editing mode for circuit layouts is ended and you are returned to the editing level
for the distribution system. Changes to an existing circuit layout are applied to all
circuits that are already using this variant.
Note!
You can automatically transfer the variant to all the circuits with the same starting
position. To do this, use:
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Abort and
The editing mode for circuit layouts is ended and you are returned to the editing level
for the distribution system. The changes to the circuit layout are not saved. Use this
function for example, if you opened the wrong circuit for editing.
Cancel
The editing mode for the circuit layout is not ended. You can continue the work.
Index
602
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
(1)
If when saving with Apply neither of the two checkboxes (1) is checked, the variant
is only applied to the current circuit. However, by selecting a setting for the variant
you can:
Make all equal original system circuits in this board use this macro
The new variant is applied to all circuits that either
Basic functions
• use the same system layout as the edited circuit or
• use the same system layout that the edited custom variant is based on.
DDS-CAD 7.3
603
Introduction
The interaction of a scenario with the selected setting results in four possible or
meaningful combinations. They are explained in the examples:
Initial situation
The circuits F1 to F3 use the system layout ZZF1A. The circuits F4 to F6 use the
variant 1 (AA), of this layout.
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
604
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
Example 1 – Scenario a)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
605
Introduction
606
DDS-CAD 7.3
Introduction
Options, settings and auxiliary functions Erro
r!
Example 3 – Scenario b)
Basic functions
Adjustments, extensions, configuration
Index
DDS-CAD 7.3
607
Introduction
By editing the existing variant 3 a modification of all circuits that use this variant to
date is automatically given. As a result of the additional transfer to the appropriate
system layouts, the circuitry of circuits F1 to F3 is displayed in the edited variant 3a.
Index
608
DDS-CAD 7.3